1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2026 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26
27 /**
28 * DOC: Introduction
29 *
30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33 * drivers.
34 */
35
36 /**
37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38 *
39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44 * tasklet function.
45 *
46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48 */
49
50 /**
51 * DOC: Warning
52 *
53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55 */
56
57 /**
58 * DOC: Frame format
59 *
60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63 * hardware.
64 *
65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66 *
67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69 *
70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72 */
73
74 /**
75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76 *
77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81 *
82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83 * suspend.
84 *
85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86 *
87 */
88
89 /**
90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91 *
92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94 * different stations/interfaces.
95 *
96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98 * handler.
99 *
100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103 *
104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106 *
107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109 * driver op.
110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113 *
114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
119 *
120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124 * .release_buffered_frames().
125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128 */
129
130 /**
131 * DOC: HW timestamping
132 *
133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135 *
136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140 *
141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145 */
146 struct device;
147
148 /**
149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150 *
151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153 */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
160
161 /**
162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167 */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
173 };
174
175 /**
176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177 *
178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180 *
181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190 */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 u16 txop;
193 u16 cw_min;
194 u16 cw_max;
195 u8 aifs;
196 bool acm;
197 bool uapsd;
198 bool mu_edca;
199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208
209 /**
210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218 * bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220 * was changed.
221 */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
224 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
225 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
226 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
227 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF = BIT(4),
228 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP = BIT(5),
229 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING = BIT(6),
230 };
231
232 /**
233 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236 * (otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237 */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242
243 /**
244 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245 *
246 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248 *
249 * @def: the channel definition
250 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252 * for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262 */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267
268 int radio_idx;
269 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270
271 bool radar_enabled;
272
273 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275
276 /**
277 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
281 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288 * for changes/removal.)
289 */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294
295 /**
296 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297 *
298 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
300 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301 * done.
302 *
303 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307 */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314
315 /**
316 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317 *
318 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320 *
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322 * also implies a change in the AID.
323 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
333 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346 * changed
347 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351 * context had been assigned.
352 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355 * keep alive) changed.
356 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364 * status changed.
365 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368 * @BSS_CHANGED_NAN_LOCAL_SCHED: NAN local schedule changed (NAN mode only)
369 */
370 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
371 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
372 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
373 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
374 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
375 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
376 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
377 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
378 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
379 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
380 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
381 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
382 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
383 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
384 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
385 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
386 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
387 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
388 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
389 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
390 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
391 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
392 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
393 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
394 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
395 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
396 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
397 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
398 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
399 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
400 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
401 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
402 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
403 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS = BIT_ULL(33),
404 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM = BIT_ULL(34),
405 BSS_CHANGED_TPE = BIT_ULL(35),
406 BSS_CHANGED_NAN_LOCAL_SCHED = BIT_ULL(36),
407
408 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
409 };
410
411 /*
412 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
413 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
414 * filtering will be disabled.
415 */
416 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
417
418 /**
419 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
420 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
421 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
422 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
423 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
424 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
425 * once each time the timeout triggers.
426 */
427 enum ieee80211_event_type {
428 RSSI_EVENT,
429 MLME_EVENT,
430 BAR_RX_EVENT,
431 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
432 };
433
434 /**
435 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
436 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
437 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
438 */
439 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
440 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
441 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
442 };
443
444 /**
445 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
446 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
447 */
448 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
449 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
450 };
451
452 /**
453 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
454 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
455 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
456 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
457 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
458 */
459 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
460 AUTH_EVENT,
461 ASSOC_EVENT,
462 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
463 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
464 };
465
466 /**
467 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
468 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
469 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
470 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
471 */
472 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
473 MLME_SUCCESS,
474 MLME_DENIED,
475 MLME_TIMEOUT,
476 };
477
478 /**
479 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
480 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
481 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
482 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
483 */
484 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
485 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
486 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
487 u16 reason;
488 };
489
490 /**
491 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
492 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
493 * @tid: the tid
494 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
495 */
496 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
497 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
498 u16 tid;
499 u16 ssn;
500 };
501
502 /**
503 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
504 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
505 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
506 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
507 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
508 * @u:union holding the fields above
509 */
510 struct ieee80211_event {
511 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
512 union {
513 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
514 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
515 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
516 } u;
517 };
518
519 /**
520 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
521 *
522 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
523 *
524 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
525 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
526 */
527 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
528 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
529 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
530 };
531
532 /**
533 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
534 *
535 * @lci: LCI subelement content
536 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
537 * @lci_len: LCI data length
538 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
539 */
540 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
541 const u8 *lci;
542 const u8 *civicloc;
543 size_t lci_len;
544 size_t civicloc_len;
545 };
546
547 /**
548 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
549 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
550 *
551 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
552 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
553 */
554 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
555 u32 min_interval;
556 u32 max_interval;
557 };
558
559 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ 5
560 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
561 bool valid;
562 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
563 u8 count;
564 };
565
566 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ 16
567 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
568 bool valid;
569 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
570 u8 count, n;
571 };
572
573 /**
574 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
575 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
576 * (indexed by TX power category)
577 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
578 * 160, 320 MHz each
579 * (indexed by TX power category)
580 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
581 * subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
582 * (indexed by TX power category)
583 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
584 * each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
585 * (indexed by TX power category)
586 */
587 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
588 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
589 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
590 };
591
592 /**
593 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
594 *
595 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
596 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
597 *
598 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
599 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
600 * when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
601 * necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
602 * responses.
603 * @addr: (link) address used locally
604 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
605 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
606 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
607 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
608 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
609 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
610 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
613 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
614 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
615 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
616 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
617 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
618 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
619 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
620 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
621 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
622 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
623 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
624 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
625 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
626 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
627 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
628 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
629 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
630 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
631 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
632 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
633 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
634 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
635 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
636 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
637 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
638 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
639 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
640 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
641 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
642 * the current band.
643 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
644 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
645 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
646 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
647 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
648 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
649 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
650 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
651 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
652 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
653 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
654 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
655 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
656 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
657 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
658 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
659 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
660 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
661 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
662 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
663 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
664 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
665 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
666 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
667 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
668 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
669 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
670 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
671 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
672 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
673 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
674 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
675 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
676 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
677 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
678 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
679 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
680 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
681 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
682 * station.
683 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
684 * responder functionality.
685 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
686 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
687 * @tx_bss_conf: Pointer to the BSS configuration of transmitting interface
688 * if MBSSID is enabled. This pointer is RCU-protected due to CSA finish
689 * and BSS color change flows accessing it.
690 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
691 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
692 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
693 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
694 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
695 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
696 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
697 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
698 * connected to (STA)
699 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
700 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
701 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
702 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
703 * interval.
704 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
705 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
706 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
707 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
708 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
709 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
710 * @epcs_support: does this BSS support EPCS
711 * @uhr_support: does this BSS support UHR
712 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
713 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
714 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
715 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
716 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
717 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
718 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
719 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
720 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
721 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
722 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
723 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
724 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
725 * beamformer
726 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
727 * beamformee
728 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
729 * beamformer
730 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
731 * beamformee
732 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
733 * beamformer
734 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
735 * beamformee
736 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
737 * beamformer
738 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
739 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
740 * bandwidth
741 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
742 * beamformer
743 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
744 * beamformee
745 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
746 * beamformer
747 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
748 * reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
749 * bandwidth
750 * @eht_disable_mcs15: disable EHT-MCS 15 reception capability.
751 * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
752 * information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
753 * beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
754 * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
755 * that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
756 * its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
757 * link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
758 * bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
759 * link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
760 * In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
761 * be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
762 * the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
763 * (as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
764 * @s1g_long_beacon_period: number of beacon intervals between each long
765 * beacon transmission.
766 */
767 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
768 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
769 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
770
771 const u8 *bssid;
772 unsigned int link_id;
773 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
774 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
775 bool uora_exists;
776 u8 uora_ocw_range;
777 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
778 bool he_support;
779 bool twt_requester;
780 bool twt_responder;
781 bool twt_protected;
782 bool twt_broadcast;
783 /* erp related data */
784 bool use_cts_prot;
785 bool use_short_preamble;
786 bool use_short_slot;
787 bool enable_beacon;
788 u8 dtim_period;
789 u16 beacon_int;
790 u16 assoc_capability;
791 u64 sync_tsf;
792 u32 sync_device_ts;
793 u8 sync_dtim_count;
794 u32 basic_rates;
795 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
796 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
797 u16 ht_operation_mode;
798 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
799 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
800 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
801 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
802 struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
803 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
804 bool qos;
805 bool hidden_ssid;
806 int txpower;
807 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
808 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
809 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
810 u16 max_idle_period;
811 bool protected_keep_alive;
812 bool ftm_responder;
813 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
814 /* Multiple BSSID data */
815 bool nontransmitted;
816 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *tx_bss_conf;
817 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
818 u8 bssid_index;
819 u8 bssid_indicator;
820 bool ema_ap;
821 u8 profile_periodicity;
822 struct {
823 u32 params;
824 u16 nss_set;
825 } he_oper;
826 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
827 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
828 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
829 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
830 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
831 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
832
833 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
834
835 u8 pwr_reduction;
836 bool eht_support;
837 bool epcs_support;
838 bool uhr_support;
839
840 bool csa_active;
841
842 bool mu_mimo_owner;
843 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
844
845 bool color_change_active;
846 u8 color_change_color;
847
848 bool ht_ldpc;
849 bool vht_ldpc;
850 bool he_ldpc;
851 bool vht_su_beamformer;
852 bool vht_su_beamformee;
853 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
854 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
855 bool he_su_beamformer;
856 bool he_su_beamformee;
857 bool he_mu_beamformer;
858 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
859 bool eht_su_beamformer;
860 bool eht_su_beamformee;
861 bool eht_mu_beamformer;
862 bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
863 bool eht_disable_mcs15;
864
865 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
866 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
867
868 u8 s1g_long_beacon_period;
869 };
870
871 #define IEEE80211_NAN_MAX_CHANNELS 3
872
873 /**
874 * struct ieee80211_nan_channel - NAN channel information
875 *
876 * @chanreq: channel request for this NAN channel. Even though this chanreq::ap
877 * is irrelevant for NAN, still store it for convenience - some functions
878 * require it as an argument.
879 * @needed_rx_chains: number of RX chains needed for this NAN channel
880 * @chanctx_conf: chanctx_conf assigned to this NAN channel.
881 * If a local channel is being ULWed (because we needed this chanctx for
882 * something else), the local NAN channel that used this chanctx,
883 * will have this pointer set to %NULL.
884 * A peer NAN channel should never have this pointer set to %NULL.
885 * @channel_entry: the Channel Entry blob as defined in Wi-Fi Aware
886 * (TM) 4.0 specification Table 100 (Channel Entry format for the NAN
887 * Availability attribute).
888 */
889 struct ieee80211_nan_channel {
890 struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
891 u8 needed_rx_chains;
892 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf;
893 u8 channel_entry[6];
894 };
895
896 /**
897 * struct ieee80211_nan_peer_map - NAN peer schedule map
898 *
899 * This stores a single map from a peer's schedule. Each peer can have
900 * multiple maps.
901 *
902 * @map_id: the map ID from the peer schedule, %CFG80211_NAN_INVALID_MAP_ID
903 * if unused
904 * @slots: mapping of time slots to channel configurations in the schedule's
905 * channels array
906 */
907 struct ieee80211_nan_peer_map {
908 u8 map_id;
909 struct ieee80211_nan_channel *slots[CFG80211_NAN_SCHED_NUM_TIME_SLOTS];
910 };
911
912 /**
913 * struct ieee80211_nan_peer_sched - NAN peer schedule
914 *
915 * This stores the complete schedule from a peer. Contains peer-level
916 * parameters and an array of schedule maps.
917 *
918 * @seq_id: the sequence ID from the peer schedule
919 * @committed_dw: committed DW as published by the peer
920 * @max_chan_switch: maximum channel switch time in microseconds
921 * @init_ulw: initial ULWs as published by the peer (copied)
922 * @ulw_size: number of bytes in @init_ulw
923 * @maps: array of peer schedule maps. Invalid slots have map_id set to
924 * %CFG80211_NAN_INVALID_MAP_ID.
925 * @n_channels: number of valid channel entries in @channels
926 * @channels: flexible array of negotiated peer channels for this schedule
927 */
928 struct ieee80211_nan_peer_sched {
929 u8 seq_id;
930 u16 committed_dw;
931 u16 max_chan_switch;
932 const u8 *init_ulw;
933 u16 ulw_size;
934 struct ieee80211_nan_peer_map maps[CFG80211_NAN_MAX_PEER_MAPS];
935 u8 n_channels;
936 struct ieee80211_nan_channel channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
937 };
938
939 /**
940 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
941 *
942 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
943 *
944 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
945 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
946 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
947 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
948 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
949 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
950 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
951 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
952 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
953 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
954 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
955 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
956 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
957 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
958 * station
959 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
960 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
961 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
962 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
963 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
964 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
965 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
966 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
967 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
968 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
969 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
970 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
971 * hardware queue.
972 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
973 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
974 * is for the whole aggregation.
975 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
976 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
977 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
978 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
979 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
980 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
981 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
982 * off-channel operation.
983 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
984 * (header conversion)
985 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
986 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
987 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
988 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
989 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
990 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
991 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
992 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
993 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
994 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
995 * queue gets full.
996 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
997 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
998 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
999 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
1000 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
1001 * should kick the MLME state machine.
1002 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
1003 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
1004 * status to user space)
1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
1006 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
1007 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
1008 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
1009 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
1010 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
1011 * handled properly by the device.
1012 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
1013 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
1014 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
1015 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
1016 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
1017 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
1018 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
1019 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
1020 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
1021 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
1022 * PS-Poll responses.
1023 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
1024 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
1025 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
1026 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
1027 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
1028 * monitor injection).
1029 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
1030 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
1031 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
1032 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
1033 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
1034 *
1035 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
1036 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
1037 */
1038 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
1039 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
1040 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
1041 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
1042 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
1043 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
1044 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
1045 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
1046 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
1047 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
1048 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
1049 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
1050 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
1051 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
1052 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
1053 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
1054 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
1055 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
1056 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
1057 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
1058 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
1059 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
1060 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
1061 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
1062 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
1063 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
1064 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
1065 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
1066 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
1067 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
1068 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
1069 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
1070 };
1071
1072 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
1073
1074 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
1075
1076 /**
1077 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
1078 *
1079 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
1080 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
1081 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
1082 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
1083 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
1084 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1085 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1086 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1087 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1088 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1089 * it can be sent out.
1090 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1091 * has already been assigned to this frame.
1092 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1093 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1094 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1095 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1096 * for sequence number assignment
1097 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1098 * which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1099 * operation on the interface.
1100 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1101 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1102 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1103 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1104 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1105 * it's intended for an MLD.
1106 *
1107 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1108 */
1109 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1110 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
1111 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
1112 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
1113 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
1114 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
1115 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
1116 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
1117 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
1118 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
1119 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
1120 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK = BIT(10),
1121 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
1122 };
1123
1124 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
1125 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
1126 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1127 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1128
1129 /**
1130 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1131 *
1132 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1133 *
1134 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1135 */
1136 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1137 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1138 };
1139
1140 /*
1141 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1142 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1143 */
1144 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
1145 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
1146 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
1147 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
1148 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
1149 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
1150 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
1151 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1152
1153 /**
1154 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1155 * Rate Control algorithm.
1156 *
1157 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1158 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1159 *
1160 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1161 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1162 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1163 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1164 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1165 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1166 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1167 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1168 * Greenfield mode.
1169 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1170 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1171 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1172 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
1173 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1174 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1175 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1176 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1177 */
1178 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1179 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1180 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1181 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1182
1183 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1184 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1185 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1186 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1187 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1188 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1189 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1190 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1191 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1192 };
1193
1194
1195 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1196 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1197
1198 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1199 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1200
1201 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1202 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1203
1204 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1205 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1206
1207 /**
1208 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1209 *
1210 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1211 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1212 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1213 *
1214 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1215 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1216 *
1217 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1218 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1219 *
1220 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1221 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1222 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1223 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1224 * information::
1225 *
1226 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1227 *
1228 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1229 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1230 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1231 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1232 * information should then contain::
1233 *
1234 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1235 *
1236 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1237 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1238 */
1239 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1240 s8 idx;
1241 u16 count:5,
1242 flags:11;
1243 } __packed;
1244
1245 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1246
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1247 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1248 {
1249 return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1250 }
1251
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1252 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1253 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1254 {
1255 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1256 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1257 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1258 }
1259
1260 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1261 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1262 {
1263 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1264 }
1265
1266 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1267 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1268 {
1269 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1270 }
1271
1272 /**
1273 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1274 *
1275 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1276 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1277 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1278 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1279 *
1280 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1281 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1282 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1283 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1284 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1285 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1286 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1287 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1288 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1289 * @control: union part for control data
1290 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1291 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1292 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1293 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1294 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1295 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1296 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1297 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1298 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1299 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1300 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1301 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1302 * @pad: padding
1303 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1304 * @status: union part for status data
1305 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1306 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1307 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1308 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1309 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1310 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1311 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1312 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1313 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1314 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1315 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1316 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1317 */
1318 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1319 /* common information */
1320 u32 flags;
1321 u32 band:3,
1322 status_data_idr:1,
1323 status_data:13,
1324 hw_queue:4,
1325 tx_time_est:10;
1326 /* 1 free bit */
1327
1328 union {
1329 struct {
1330 union {
1331 /* rate control */
1332 struct {
1333 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1334 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1335 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1336 u8 use_rts:1;
1337 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1338 u8 short_preamble:1;
1339 u8 skip_table:1;
1340
1341 /* for injection only (bitmap) */
1342 u8 antennas:2;
1343
1344 /* 14 bits free */
1345 };
1346 /* only needed before rate control */
1347 unsigned long jiffies;
1348 };
1349 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1350 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1351 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1352 u32 flags;
1353 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1354 } control;
1355 struct {
1356 u64 cookie;
1357 } ack;
1358 struct {
1359 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1360 s32 ack_signal;
1361 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1362 u8 ampdu_len;
1363 u8 antenna;
1364 u8 pad;
1365 u16 tx_time;
1366 u8 flags;
1367 u8 pad2;
1368 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1369 } status;
1370 struct {
1371 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1372 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1373 u8 pad[4];
1374
1375 void *rate_driver_data[
1376 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1377 };
1378 void *driver_data[
1379 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1380 };
1381 };
1382
1383 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1384 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1385 {
1386 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1387 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1388 */
1389 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1390 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1391 }
1392
1393 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1394 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1395 {
1396 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1397 }
1398
1399 /***
1400 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1401 *
1402 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1403 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1404 *
1405 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1406 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1407 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1408 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1409 * that was used when sending the packet.
1410 */
1411 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1412 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1413 u8 try_count;
1414 u8 tx_power_idx;
1415 };
1416
1417 /**
1418 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1419 *
1420 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1421 * @info: Basic tx status information
1422 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1423 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1424 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1425 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1426 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1427 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1428 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1429 */
1430 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1431 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1432 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1433 struct sk_buff *skb;
1434 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1435 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1436 u8 n_rates;
1437
1438 struct list_head *free_list;
1439 };
1440
1441 /**
1442 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1443 *
1444 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1445 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1446 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1447 *
1448 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1449 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1450 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1451 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1452 */
1453 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1454 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1455 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1456 const u8 *common_ies;
1457 size_t common_ie_len;
1458 };
1459
1460
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1461 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1462 {
1463 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1464 }
1465
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1466 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1467 {
1468 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1469 }
1470
1471 /**
1472 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1473 *
1474 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1475 *
1476 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1477 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1478 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1479 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1480 *
1481 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1482 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1483 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1484 */
1485 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1486 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1487 {
1488 int i;
1489
1490 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1491 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1492 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1493 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1494 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1495 /* clear the rate counts */
1496 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1497 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1498 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1499 }
1500
1501
1502 /**
1503 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1504 *
1505 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1506 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1507 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1508 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1509 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1510 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1511 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1512 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1513 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1514 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1515 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1516 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1517 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1518 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1519 * de-duplication by itself.
1520 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1521 * the frame.
1522 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1523 * the frame.
1524 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1525 * field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1526 * where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1527 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1528 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1529 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1530 * merging.
1531 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1532 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1533 * (including FCS) was received.
1534 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1535 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1536 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1537 * is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1538 * @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1539 * %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1540 * reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1541 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1542 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1543 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1544 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1545 * each A-MPDU
1546 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1547 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1548 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1549 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1550 * on this subframe
1551 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1552 * done by the hardware
1553 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1554 * processing it in any regular way.
1555 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1556 * them for sniffing purposes.
1557 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1558 * monitor interfaces.
1559 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1560 * them for sniffing purposes.
1561 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1562 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1563 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1564 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1565 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1566 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1567 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1568 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1569 * interleaved with other frames.
1570 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1571 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1572 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1573 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1574 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1575 * in the skb.
1576 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1577 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1578 * the first subframe.
1579 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1580 * be done in the hardware.
1581 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1582 * frame
1583 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1584 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1585 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1586 *
1587 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1588 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1589 * - DATA3_CODING
1590 * - DATA5_GI
1591 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1592 * - DATA6_NSTS
1593 * - DATA3_STBC
1594 *
1595 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1596 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1597 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1598 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1599 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1600 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1601 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1602 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1603 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1604 * hardware or driver)
1605 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT: VHT radiotap data is present
1606 */
1607 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1608 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1609 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1610 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(2),
1611 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1612 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1613 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1614 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1615 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64 = BIT(7),
1616 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1617 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1618 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1619 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1620 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1621 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1622 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1623 /* one free bit at 15 */
1624 RX_FLAG_MACTIME = BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1625 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = 1 << 16,
1626 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = 2 << 16,
1627 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = 3 << 16,
1628 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1629 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1630 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20),
1631 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1632 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1633 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1634 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1635 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1636 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1637 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1638 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1639 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1640 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1641 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT = BIT(31),
1642 };
1643
1644 /**
1645 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1646 *
1647 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1648 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1649 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1650 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1651 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1652 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1653 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1654 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1655 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1656 */
1657 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1658 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1659 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1660 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1661 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1662 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1663 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1664 };
1665
1666 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1667
1668 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1669 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1670 RX_ENC_HT,
1671 RX_ENC_VHT,
1672 RX_ENC_HE,
1673 RX_ENC_EHT,
1674 RX_ENC_UHR,
1675 };
1676
1677 /**
1678 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1679 *
1680 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1681 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1682 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1683 *
1684 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1685 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1686 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1687 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1688 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1689 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1690 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1691 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1692 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1693 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1694 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1695 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1696 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1697 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1698 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1699 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1700 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1701 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1702 * values were filled.
1703 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1704 * support dB or unspecified units)
1705 * @antenna: antenna used
1706 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1707 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1708 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE, EHT and UHR only)
1709 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1710 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1711 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1712 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1713 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1714 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1715 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1716 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1717 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1718 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1719 * @uhr: UHR specific rate information
1720 * @uhr.ru: UHR RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1721 * @uhr.gi: UHR GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1722 * @uhr.elr: UHR ELR MCS was used
1723 * @uhr.im: UHR interference mitigation was used
1724 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1725 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1726 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1727 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1728 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1729 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1730 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1731 * @link_valid.
1732 */
1733 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1734 u64 mactime;
1735 union {
1736 u64 boottime_ns;
1737 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1738 };
1739 u32 device_timestamp;
1740 u32 ampdu_reference;
1741 u32 flag;
1742 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1743 u8 enc_flags;
1744 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1745 union {
1746 struct {
1747 u8 he_ru:3;
1748 u8 he_gi:2;
1749 u8 he_dcm:1;
1750 };
1751 struct {
1752 u8 ru:4;
1753 u8 gi:2;
1754 } eht;
1755 struct {
1756 u8 ru:4;
1757 u8 gi:2;
1758 u8 elr:1;
1759 u8 im:1;
1760 } uhr;
1761 };
1762 u8 rate_idx;
1763 u8 nss;
1764 u8 rx_flags;
1765 u8 band;
1766 u8 antenna;
1767 s8 signal;
1768 u8 chains;
1769 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1770 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1771 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1772 };
1773
1774 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1775 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1776 {
1777 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1778 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1779 }
1780
1781 /**
1782 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1783 *
1784 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1785 *
1786 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1787 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1788 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1789 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1790 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1791 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1792 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1793 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1794 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1795 * for more.
1796 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1797 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1798 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1799 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1800 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1801 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1802 * operating channel.
1803 */
1804 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1805 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1806 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1807 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1808 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1809 };
1810
1811
1812 /**
1813 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1814 *
1815 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1816 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1817 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1818 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1819 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1820 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1821 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1822 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1823 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1824 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1825 */
1826 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1827 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1828 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1829 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1830 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1831 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1832 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1833 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1834 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1835 };
1836
1837 /**
1838 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1839 *
1840 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1841 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1842 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1843 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1844 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1845 */
1846 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1847 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1848 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1849 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1850 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1851
1852 /* keep last */
1853 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1854 };
1855
1856 /**
1857 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1858 *
1859 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1860 *
1861 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1862 *
1863 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1864 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1865 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1866 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1867 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1868 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1869 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1870 *
1871 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1872 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1873 *
1874 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1875 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1876 *
1877 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1878 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1879 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1880 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1881 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1882 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1883 *
1884 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1885 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1886 * configured for an HT channel.
1887 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1888 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1889 */
1890 struct ieee80211_conf {
1891 u32 flags;
1892 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1893
1894 u16 listen_interval;
1895 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1896
1897 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1898
1899 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1900 bool radar_enabled;
1901 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1902 };
1903
1904 /**
1905 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1906 *
1907 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1908 * operation.
1909 *
1910 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1911 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1912 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1913 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1914 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1915 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1916 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1917 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1918 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1919 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1920 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1921 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1922 * channel, expressed in TU.
1923 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1924 */
1925 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1926 u64 timestamp;
1927 u32 device_timestamp;
1928 bool block_tx;
1929 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1930 u8 count;
1931 u8 link_id;
1932 u32 delay;
1933 };
1934
1935 /**
1936 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1937 *
1938 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1939 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1940 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1941 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1942 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1943 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1944 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1945 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1946 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1947 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1948 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1949 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1950 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1951 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1952 * enabled for the interface.
1953 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1954 * operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1955 * the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1956 * handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1957 * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
1958 * be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
1959 * opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
1960 */
1961 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1962 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1963 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1964 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1965 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1966 IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE = BIT(4),
1967 IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW = BIT(5),
1968 IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC = BIT(6),
1969 };
1970
1971
1972 /**
1973 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1974 *
1975 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1976 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1977 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1978 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1979 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1980 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1981 * mac80211.
1982 */
1983
1984 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1985 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1986 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1987 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1988 };
1989
1990 #define IEEE80211_NAN_AVAIL_BLOB_MAX_LEN 54
1991
1992 /**
1993 * struct ieee80211_eml_params - EHT Operating mode notification parameters
1994 *
1995 * EML Operating mode notification parameters received in the Operating mode
1996 * notification frame. This struct is used as a container to pass the info to
1997 * the underlay driver.
1998 *
1999 * @link_id: the link ID where the Operating mode notification frame has been
2000 * received.
2001 * @control: EML control field defined in P802.11be section 9.4.1.76.
2002 * @link_bitmap: eMLSR/eMLMR enabled links defined in P802.11be
2003 * section 9.4.1.76.
2004 * @emlmr_mcs_map_count: eMLMR number of valid mcs_map_bw fields according to
2005 * P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
2006 * @emlmr_mcs_map_bw: eMLMR supported MCS and NSS set subfileds defined in
2007 * P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
2008 */
2009 struct ieee80211_eml_params {
2010 u8 link_id;
2011 u8 control;
2012 u16 link_bitmap;
2013 u8 emlmr_mcs_map_count;
2014 u8 emlmr_mcs_map_bw[9];
2015 };
2016
2017 /**
2018 * struct ieee80211_nan_sched_cfg - NAN schedule configuration
2019 * @channels: array of NAN channels. A channel entry is in use if
2020 * channels[i].chanreq.oper.chan is not NULL.
2021 * @schedule: NAN local schedule - mapping of each 16TU time slot to
2022 * the NAN channel on which the radio will operate. NULL if unscheduled.
2023 * @avail_blob: NAN Availability attribute blob.
2024 * @avail_blob_len: length of the @avail_blob in bytes.
2025 * @deferred: indicates that the driver should notify peers before applying the
2026 * new NAN schedule, and apply the new schedule the second NAN Slot
2027 * boundary after it notified the peers, as defined in Wi-Fi Aware (TM) 4.0
2028 * specification, section 5.2.2.
2029 * The driver must call ieee80211_nan_sched_update_done() after the
2030 * schedule has been applied.
2031 * If a HW restart happened while a deferred schedule update was pending,
2032 * mac80211 will reconfigure the deferred schedule (and wait for the driver
2033 * to notify that the schedule has been applied).
2034 */
2035 struct ieee80211_nan_sched_cfg {
2036 struct ieee80211_nan_channel channels[IEEE80211_NAN_MAX_CHANNELS];
2037 struct ieee80211_nan_channel *schedule[CFG80211_NAN_SCHED_NUM_TIME_SLOTS];
2038 u8 avail_blob[IEEE80211_NAN_AVAIL_BLOB_MAX_LEN];
2039 u16 avail_blob_len;
2040 bool deferred;
2041 };
2042
2043 /**
2044 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
2045 * @assoc: association status
2046 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
2047 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
2048 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
2049 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
2050 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
2051 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
2052 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
2053 * P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
2054 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
2055 * Figure 9-1001k
2056 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
2057 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
2058 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
2059 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
2060 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
2061 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
2062 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
2063 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
2064 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
2065 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
2066 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
2067 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
2068 * your driver/device needs to do.
2069 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
2070 * (station mode only)
2071 * @nan_sched: NAN schedule parameters. &struct ieee80211_nan_sched_cfg
2072 */
2073 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
2074 /* association related data */
2075 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
2076 bool ibss_creator;
2077 bool ps;
2078 u16 aid;
2079 u16 eml_cap;
2080 u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
2081 u16 mld_capa_op;
2082
2083 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
2084 int arp_addr_cnt;
2085 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2086 size_t ssid_len;
2087 bool s1g;
2088 bool idle;
2089 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2090 /* Protected by the wiphy mutex */
2091 struct ieee80211_nan_sched_cfg nan_sched;
2092 };
2093
2094 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
2095
2096 /**
2097 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
2098 *
2099 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
2100 * this TID is not included.
2101 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
2102 * TID is not included.
2103 * @valid: info is valid or not.
2104 */
2105 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
2106 u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
2107 u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
2108 bool valid;
2109 };
2110
2111 /**
2112 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
2113 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
2114 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
2115 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
2116 */
2117 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
2118 NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
2119 NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
2120 NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
2121 };
2122
2123 /**
2124 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
2125 *
2126 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
2127 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
2128 *
2129 * @type: type of this virtual interface
2130 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
2131 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
2132 * or the BSS we're associated to
2133 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
2134 * indexed by link ID
2135 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
2136 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
2137 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
2138 * API calls meant for that purpose.
2139 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
2140 * due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
2141 * 0 for non-MLO.
2142 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
2143 * suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
2144 * future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
2145 * 0 for non-MLO.
2146 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
2147 * see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
2148 * @addr: address of this interface
2149 * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
2150 * passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
2151 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
2152 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
2153 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
2154 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
2155 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
2156 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
2157 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
2158 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2159 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2160 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2161 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2162 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2163 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2164 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2165 * restrictions.
2166 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2167 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2168 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2169 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2170 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2171 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2172 * interface.
2173 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2174 * for this interface.
2175 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2176 * sizeof(void \*).
2177 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2178 * @txq_mgmt: the mgmt frame TX queue, currently only exists for NAN devices
2179 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2180 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2181 */
2182 struct ieee80211_vif {
2183 enum nl80211_iftype type;
2184 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2185 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2186 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2187 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2188 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2189 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2190 bool addr_valid;
2191 bool p2p;
2192
2193 u8 cab_queue;
2194 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2195
2196 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2197 struct ieee80211_txq *txq_mgmt;
2198
2199 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2200 u32 driver_flags;
2201 u32 offload_flags;
2202
2203 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2204 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2205 #endif
2206
2207 bool probe_req_reg;
2208 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2209
2210 /* must be last */
2211 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2212 };
2213
2214 /**
2215 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2216 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2217 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2218 */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2219 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2220 {
2221 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2222 }
2223
2224 /**
2225 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2226 * @vif: the vif
2227 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2228 */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2229 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2230 {
2231 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2232 return vif->valid_links != 0;
2233 }
2234
2235 /**
2236 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2237 * @vif: the vif
2238 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2239 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2240 * the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2241 */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2242 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2243 unsigned int link_id)
2244 {
2245 if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2246 return link_id == 0;
2247 return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2248 }
2249
2250 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
2251 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
2252 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2253 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2254 (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2255
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2256 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2257 {
2258 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2259 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2260 #endif
2261 return false;
2262 }
2263
2264 /**
2265 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2266 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2267 *
2268 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2269 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2270 *
2271 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2272 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2273 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2274 */
2275 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2276
2277 /**
2278 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2279 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2280 *
2281 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2282 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2283 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2284 *
2285 * Return: pointer to the wdev
2286 */
2287 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2288
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2289 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2290 {
2291 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2292 }
2293
2294 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
2295 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2296 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2297
2298 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
2299 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2300 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2301
2302 /**
2303 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2304 *
2305 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2306 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2307 *
2308 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2309 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2310 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2311 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2312 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2313 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2314 * generation in software.
2315 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2316 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2317 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2318 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2319 * (MFP) to be done in software.
2320 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2321 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2322 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2323 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2324 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2325 * MIC.
2326 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2327 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2328 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2329 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2330 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2331 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2332 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2333 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2334 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2335 * only for management frames (MFP).
2336 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2337 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2338 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2339 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2340 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2341 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2342 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2343 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2344 * for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2345 * number generation only
2346 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2347 * (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2348 */
2349 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2350 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2351 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2352 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2353 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2354 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2355 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2356 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2357 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2358 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2359 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2360 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2361 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(11),
2362 };
2363
2364 /**
2365 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2366 *
2367 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2368 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2369 *
2370 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2371 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2372 * encrypted in hardware.
2373 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2374 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2375 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2376 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2377 * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
2378 * @keylen: key material length
2379 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2380 * data block:
2381 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2382 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2383 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2384 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2385 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2386 * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
2387 */
2388 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2389 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2390 u32 cipher;
2391 u8 icv_len;
2392 u8 iv_len;
2393 u8 hw_key_idx;
2394 s8 keyidx;
2395 u16 flags;
2396 s8 link_id;
2397 u8 keylen;
2398 u8 key[];
2399 };
2400
2401 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2402
2403 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2404 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2405
2406 /**
2407 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2408 *
2409 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2410 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2411 * reverse order than in packet)
2412 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2413 * reverse order than in packet)
2414 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2415 * reverse order than in packet)
2416 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2417 * reverse order than in packet)
2418 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2419 */
2420 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2421 union {
2422 struct {
2423 u32 iv32;
2424 u16 iv16;
2425 } tkip;
2426 struct {
2427 u8 pn[6];
2428 } ccmp;
2429 struct {
2430 u8 pn[6];
2431 } aes_cmac;
2432 struct {
2433 u8 pn[6];
2434 } aes_gmac;
2435 struct {
2436 u8 pn[6];
2437 } gcmp;
2438 struct {
2439 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2440 u8 seq_len;
2441 } hw;
2442 };
2443 };
2444
2445 /**
2446 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2447 *
2448 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2449 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2450 *
2451 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2452 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2453 */
2454 enum set_key_cmd {
2455 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2456 };
2457
2458 /**
2459 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2460 *
2461 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2462 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2463 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2464 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2465 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2466 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2467 */
2468 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2469 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2470 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2471 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2472 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2473 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2474 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2475 };
2476
2477 /**
2478 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2479 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2480 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2481 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2482 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2483 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2484 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2485 *
2486 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2487 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2488 */
2489 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2490 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2491 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2492 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2493 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2494 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2495 };
2496
2497 #define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320
2498
2499 /**
2500 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2501 *
2502 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2503 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2504 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2505 */
2506 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2507 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2508 struct {
2509 s8 idx;
2510 u8 count;
2511 u8 count_cts;
2512 u8 count_rts;
2513 u16 flags;
2514 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2515 };
2516
2517 /**
2518 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2519 *
2520 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2521 *
2522 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2523 * to the STA.
2524 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2525 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2526 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2527 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2528 * per peer TPC.
2529 */
2530 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2531 s16 power;
2532 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2533 };
2534
2535 /**
2536 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2537 *
2538 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2539 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2540 *
2541 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2542 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2543 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2544 *
2545 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2546 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2547 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2548 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2549 *
2550 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2551 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2552 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2553 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2554 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2555 */
2556 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2557 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2558
2559 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2560 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2561 };
2562
2563 /**
2564 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2565 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2566 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2567 *
2568 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2569 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2570 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2571 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2572 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2573 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2574 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2575 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2576 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2577 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2578 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2579 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2580 * @uhr_cap: UHR capabilities of this STA
2581 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities of this STA
2582 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2583 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with.
2584 * This is the minimum between the peer's capabilities and our own
2585 * operating channel width; Invalid for NAN since that is operating on
2586 * multiple channels.
2587 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2588 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2589 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2590 * the station moves to associated state. Invalid for NAN since it
2591 * operates on multiple configurations of rx_nss.
2592 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2593 *
2594 */
2595 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2596 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2597
2598 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2599 u8 link_id;
2600 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2601
2602 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2603 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2604 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2605 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2606 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2607 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2608 struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap uhr_cap;
2609 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
2610
2611 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2612
2613 u8 rx_nss;
2614 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2615 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2616 };
2617
2618 /**
2619 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2620 *
2621 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2622 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2623 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2624 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2625 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2626 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2627 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2628 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2629 *
2630 * @addr: MAC address
2631 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2632 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2633 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2634 * Can be modified by driver.
2635 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2636 * otherwise always false)
2637 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2638 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2639 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2640 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2641 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2642 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2643 * @rates: rate control selection table
2644 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2645 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2646 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2647 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2648 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2649 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2650 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2651 * unlimited.
2652 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities of this MLO station
2653 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2654 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2655 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2656 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2657 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2658 * is used for non-data frames
2659 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2660 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2661 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2662 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2663 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2664 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2665 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2666 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2667 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2668 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2669 * by the AP.
2670 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2671 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2672 * @epp_peer: indicates that the peer is an EPP peer.
2673 * @nmi: For NDI stations, pointer to the NMI station of the peer.
2674 * @nan_sched: NAN peer schedule for this station. Valid only for NMI stations.
2675 */
2676 struct ieee80211_sta {
2677 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2678 u16 aid;
2679 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2680 bool wme;
2681 u8 uapsd_queues;
2682 u8 max_sp;
2683 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2684 bool tdls;
2685 bool tdls_initiator;
2686 bool mfp;
2687 bool mlo;
2688 bool spp_amsdu;
2689 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2690 u16 eml_cap;
2691
2692 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2693
2694 bool support_p2p_ps;
2695
2696 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2697
2698 u16 valid_links;
2699 bool epp_peer;
2700 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2701 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2702
2703 struct ieee80211_sta __rcu *nmi;
2704
2705 /* should only be accessed with the wiphy mutex held */
2706 struct ieee80211_nan_peer_sched *nan_sched;
2707
2708 /* must be last */
2709 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2710 };
2711
2712 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2713 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2714 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2715 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2716 {
2717 return true;
2718 }
2719 #endif
2720
2721 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2722 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2723 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2724
2725 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2726 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2727 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2728
2729 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2730 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2731 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2732 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2733 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2734
2735 /**
2736 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2737 *
2738 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2739 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2740 *
2741 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2742 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2743 */
2744 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2745 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2746 };
2747
2748 /**
2749 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2750 *
2751 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2752 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2753 */
2754 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2755 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2756 };
2757
2758 /**
2759 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2760 *
2761 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2762 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2763 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2764 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2765 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2766 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2767 *
2768 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2769 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2770 */
2771 struct ieee80211_txq {
2772 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2773 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2774 u8 tid;
2775 u8 ac;
2776
2777 /* must be last */
2778 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2779 };
2780
2781 /**
2782 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2783 *
2784 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2785 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2786 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2787 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2788 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2789 *
2790 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2791 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2792 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2793 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2794 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2795 * algorithm.
2796 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2797 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2798 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2799 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2800 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2801 * CCK frames.
2802 *
2803 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2804 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2805 * the FCS at the end.
2806 *
2807 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2808 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2809 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2810 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2811 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2812 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2813 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2814 *
2815 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2816 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2817 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2818 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2819 *
2820 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2821 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2822 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2823 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2824 *
2825 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2826 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2827 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2828 *
2829 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2830 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2831 *
2832 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2833 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2834 *
2835 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2836 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2837 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2838 *
2839 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2840 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2841 *
2842 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2843 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2844 *
2845 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2846 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2847 * the stack.
2848 *
2849 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2850 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2851 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2852 *
2853 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2854 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2855 * dtim_period).
2856 *
2857 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2858 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2859 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2860 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2861 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2862 * only in that case.
2863 *
2864 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2865 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2866 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2867 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2868 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2869 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2870 *
2871 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2872 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2873 * software.
2874 *
2875 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2876 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2877 * active interfaces.
2878 *
2879 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2880 * of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2881 * This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2882 * channels.
2883 *
2884 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2885 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2886 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2887 *
2888 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2889 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2890 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2891 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2892 * supported cipher suites.
2893 *
2894 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2895 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2896 * for frames.
2897 *
2898 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2899 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2900 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2901 * control for more details.
2902 *
2903 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2904 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2905 *
2906 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2907 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2908 * is supported.
2909 *
2910 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2911 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2912 *
2913 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2914 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2915 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2916 *
2917 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2918 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2919 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2920 * CSA frame.
2921 *
2922 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2923 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2924 *
2925 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2926 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2927 *
2928 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2929 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2930 *
2931 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2932 * within A-MPDU.
2933 *
2934 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2935 * for sent beacons.
2936 *
2937 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2938 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2939 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2940 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2941 * Note that this doesn't apply for NAN, in which the peer's NMI address
2942 * can be equal to its NDI address.
2943 *
2944 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2945 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2946 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2947 * timeout.
2948 *
2949 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2950 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2951 *
2952 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2953 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2954 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2955 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2956 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2957 *
2958 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2959 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2960 *
2961 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2962 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2963 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2964 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2965 *
2966 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2967 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2968 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2969 *
2970 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2971 * TDLS links.
2972 *
2973 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2974 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2975 *
2976 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2977 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2978 *
2979 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2980 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2981 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2982 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2983 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2984 *
2985 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2986 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2987 * TXQs to start with.
2988 *
2989 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2990 * length in tx status information
2991 *
2992 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2993 *
2994 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2995 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2996 *
2997 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2998 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2999 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
3000 *
3001 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
3002 * offload
3003 *
3004 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
3005 * offload
3006 *
3007 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
3008 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
3009 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
3010 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
3011 * the stack.
3012 *
3013 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
3014 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
3015 *
3016 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
3017 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
3018 *
3019 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
3020 * and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
3021 *
3022 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
3023 * no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
3024 * implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
3025 * link is switching.
3026 *
3027 * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
3028 * but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
3029 * HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
3030 * testing.
3031 *
3032 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_NDP_BLOCKACK: HW can transmit/receive S1G NDP
3033 * BlockAck frames.
3034 *
3035 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
3036 */
3037 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
3038 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
3039 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
3040 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
3041 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
3042 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
3043 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
3044 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
3045 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
3046 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
3047 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
3048 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
3049 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
3050 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
3051 IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
3052 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
3053 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
3054 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
3055 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
3056 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
3057 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
3058 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
3059 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
3060 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
3061 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
3062 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
3063 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
3064 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
3065 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
3066 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
3067 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
3068 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
3069 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
3070 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
3071 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
3072 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
3073 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
3074 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
3075 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
3076 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
3077 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
3078 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
3079 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
3080 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
3081 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
3082 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
3083 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
3084 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
3085 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
3086 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
3087 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
3088 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
3089 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
3090 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
3091 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
3092 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
3093 IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
3094 IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
3095 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_NDP_BLOCKACK,
3096
3097 /* keep last, obviously */
3098 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
3099 };
3100
3101 /**
3102 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
3103 *
3104 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
3105 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
3106 *
3107 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
3108 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
3109 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
3110 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
3111 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
3112 *
3113 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
3114 *
3115 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
3116 * along with this structure.
3117 *
3118 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
3119 *
3120 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
3121 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
3122 *
3123 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
3124 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
3125 *
3126 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
3127 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
3128 *
3129 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
3130 * that HW supports
3131 *
3132 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
3133 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
3134 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
3135 *
3136 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
3137 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
3138 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
3139 *
3140 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3141 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
3142 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3143 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
3144 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3145 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
3146 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3147 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
3148 *
3149 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
3150 * can handle.
3151 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
3152 * the hw can report back.
3153 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
3154 *
3155 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
3156 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
3157 * aggregation.
3158 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
3159 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
3160 * it shouldn't be set.
3161 *
3162 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
3163 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
3164 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
3165 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
3166 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
3167 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
3168 *
3169 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
3170 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
3171 *
3172 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
3173 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
3174 *
3175 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
3176 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
3177 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
3178 * adding _BW is supported today.
3179 *
3180 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
3181 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
3182 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
3183 *
3184 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
3185 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
3186 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
3187 * device_timestamp.
3188 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3189 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3190 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3191 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3192 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3193 *
3194 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3195 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3196 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3197 *
3198 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3199 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3200 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3201 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3202 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3203 * neither enabled.
3204 *
3205 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3206 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3207 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3208 *
3209 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3210 * device.
3211 *
3212 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3213 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3214 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3215 *
3216 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3217 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3218 *
3219 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3220 *
3221 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3222 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3223 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3224 *
3225 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3226 */
3227 struct ieee80211_hw {
3228 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3229 struct wiphy *wiphy;
3230 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3231 void *priv;
3232 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3233 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3234 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3235 int vif_data_size;
3236 int sta_data_size;
3237 int chanctx_data_size;
3238 int txq_data_size;
3239 u16 queues;
3240 u16 max_listen_interval;
3241 s8 max_signal;
3242 u8 max_rates;
3243 u8 max_report_rates;
3244 u8 max_rate_tries;
3245 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3246 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3247 u8 max_tx_fragments;
3248 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3249 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3250 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3251 struct {
3252 int units_pos;
3253 s16 accuracy;
3254 } radiotap_timestamp;
3255 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3256 u8 uapsd_queues;
3257 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3258 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3259 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3260 u8 weight_multiplier;
3261 u32 max_mtu;
3262 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3263 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3264 };
3265
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3266 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3267 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3268 {
3269 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3270 }
3271 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3272
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3273 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3274 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3275 {
3276 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3277 }
3278 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3279
3280 /**
3281 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3282 *
3283 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3284 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3285 */
3286 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3287 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3288
3289 /* Keep last */
3290 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3291 };
3292
3293 /**
3294 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3295 *
3296 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3297 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3298 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3299 * @status: channel-switch response status
3300 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3301 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3302 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3303 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3304 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3305 */
3306 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3307 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3308 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3309 u8 action_code;
3310 u32 status;
3311 u32 timestamp;
3312 u16 switch_time;
3313 u16 switch_timeout;
3314 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3315 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3316 };
3317
3318 /**
3319 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3320 *
3321 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3322 *
3323 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3324 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3325 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3326 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3327 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3328 *
3329 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3330 */
3331 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3332
3333 /**
3334 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3335 *
3336 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3337 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3338 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3339 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3340 {
3341 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3342 }
3343
3344 /**
3345 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3346 *
3347 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3348 * @addr: the address to set
3349 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3350 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3351 {
3352 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3353 }
3354
3355 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3356 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3357 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3358 {
3359 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3360 return NULL;
3361
3362 if (c->band >= NUM_NL80211_BANDS)
3363 return NULL;
3364
3365 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3366 }
3367
3368 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3369 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3370 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3371 {
3372 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3373 return NULL;
3374 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3375 }
3376
3377 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3378 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3379 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3380 {
3381 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3382 return NULL;
3383 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3384 }
3385
3386 /**
3387 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3388 * @hw: the hardware
3389 * @skb: the skb
3390 *
3391 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3392 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3393 */
3394 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3395
3396 /**
3397 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3398 * @hw: the hardware
3399 * @skbs: the skbs
3400 *
3401 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3402 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3403 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3404 * relevant locks to use it.
3405 */
3406 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3407 struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3408
3409 /**
3410 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3411 *
3412 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3413 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3414 *
3415 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3416 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3417 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3418 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3419 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3420 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3421 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3422 *
3423 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3424 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3425 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3426 *
3427 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3428 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3429 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3430 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3431 *
3432 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3433 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3434 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3435 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3436 *
3437 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3438 *
3439 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3440 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3441 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3442 * based on the receive flags.
3443 *
3444 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3445 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3446 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3447 * keys.
3448 *
3449 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3450 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3451 * handler.
3452 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3453 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3454 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3455 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3456 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3457 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3458 *
3459 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3460 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3461 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3462 *
3463 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3464 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3465 * requirements:
3466 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3467 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3468 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3469 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3470 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3471 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3472 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3473 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3474 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3475 */
3476
3477 /**
3478 * DOC: Powersave support
3479 *
3480 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3481 *
3482 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3483 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3484 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3485 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3486 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3487 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3488 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3489 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3490 *
3491 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3492 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3493 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3494 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3495 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3496 *
3497 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3498 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3499 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3500 *
3501 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3502 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3503 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3504 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3505 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3506 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3507 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3508 *
3509 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3510 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3511 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3512 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3513 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3514 * periods.
3515 *
3516 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3517 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3518 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3519 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3520 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3521 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3522 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3523 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3524 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3525 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3526 *
3527 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3528 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3529 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3530 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3531 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3532 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3533 *
3534 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3535 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3536 */
3537
3538 /**
3539 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3540 *
3541 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3542 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3543 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3544 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3545 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3546 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3547 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3548 *
3549 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3550 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3551 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3552 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3553 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3554 *
3555 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3556 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3557 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3558 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3559 *
3560 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3561 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3562 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3563 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3564 *
3565 * - a list of information element IDs
3566 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3567 *
3568 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3569 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3570 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3571 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3572 * vendor information elements.
3573 *
3574 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3575 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3576 *
3577 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3578 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3579 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3580 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3581 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3582 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3583 *
3584 *
3585 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3586 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3587 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3588 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3589 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3590 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3591 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3592 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3593 *
3594 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3595 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3596 * signal strength threshold checking.
3597 */
3598
3599 /**
3600 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3601 *
3602 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3603 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3604 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3605 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3606 *
3607 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3608 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3609 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3610 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3611 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3612 * hardware flags.
3613 *
3614 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3615 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3616 * turned off otherwise.
3617 *
3618 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3619 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3620 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3621 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3622 */
3623
3624 /**
3625 * DOC: Frame filtering
3626 *
3627 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3628 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3629 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3630 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3631 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3632 *
3633 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3634 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3635 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3636 *
3637 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3638 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3639 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3640 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3641 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3642 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3643 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3644 *
3645 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3646 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3647 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3648 * or dropped.
3649 *
3650 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3651 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3652 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3653 * the flag, but not clear it.
3654 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3655 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3656 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3657 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3658 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3659 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3660 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3661 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3662 */
3663
3664 /**
3665 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3666 *
3667 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3668 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3669 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3670 *
3671 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3672 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3673 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3674 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3675 * the driver code.
3676 *
3677 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3678 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3679 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3680 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3681 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3682 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3683 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3684 *
3685 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3686 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3687 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3688 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3689 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3690 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3691 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3692 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3693 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3694 * @sta_notify callback.
3695 *
3696 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3697 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3698 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3699 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3700 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3701 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3702 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3703 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3704 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3705 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3706 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3707 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3708 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3709 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3710 *
3711 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3712 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3713 *
3714 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3715 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3716 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3717 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3718 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3719 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3720 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3721 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3722 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3723 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3724 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3725 *
3726 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3727 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3728 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3729 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3730 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3731 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3732 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3733 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3734 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3735 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3736 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3737 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3738 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3739 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3740 *
3741 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3742 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3743 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3744 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3745 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3746 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3747 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3748 *
3749 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3750 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3751 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3752 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3753 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3754 *
3755 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3756 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3757 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3758 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3759 */
3760
3761 /**
3762 * DOC: HW queue control
3763 *
3764 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3765 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3766 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3767 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3768 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3769 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3770 *
3771 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3772 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3773 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3774 *
3775 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3776 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3777 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3778 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3779 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3780 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3781 * the hardware queue.
3782 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3783 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3784 *
3785 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3786 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3787 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3788 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3789 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3790 *
3791 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3792 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3793 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3794 * off-channel queue: 9
3795 *
3796 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3797 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3798 *
3799 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3800 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3801 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3802 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3803 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3804 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3805 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3806 *
3807 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3808 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3809 *
3810 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3811 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3812 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3813 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3814 */
3815
3816 /**
3817 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3818 *
3819 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3820 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3821 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3822 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3823 *
3824 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3825 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3826 * multicast address.
3827 *
3828 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3829 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3830 *
3831 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3832 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3833 *
3834 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3835 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3836 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3837 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3838 * honour this flag if possible.
3839 *
3840 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3841 * station
3842 *
3843 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3844 *
3845 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3846 *
3847 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3848 *
3849 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3850 */
3851 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3852 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3853 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3854 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3855 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3856 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3857 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3858 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3859 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3860 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3861 };
3862
3863 /**
3864 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3865 *
3866 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3867 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3868 *
3869 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3870 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3871 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3872 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3873 *
3874 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3875 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3876 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3877 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3878 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3879 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3880 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3881 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3882 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3883 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3884 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3885 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3886 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3887 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3888 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3889 * session is gone and removes the station.
3890 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3891 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3892 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3893 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3894 */
3895 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3896 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3897 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3898 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3899 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3900 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3901 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3902 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3903 };
3904
3905 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3906 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3907
3908 /**
3909 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3910 *
3911 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3912 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3913 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3914 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3915 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3916 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3917 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3918 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3919 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3920 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3921 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3922 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3923 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3924 */
3925 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3926 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3927 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3928 u16 tid;
3929 u16 ssn;
3930 u16 buf_size;
3931 bool amsdu;
3932 u16 timeout;
3933 };
3934
3935 /**
3936 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3937 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3938 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3939 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3940 */
3941 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3942 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3943 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3944 };
3945
3946 /**
3947 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3948 *
3949 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3950 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3951 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3952 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3953 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3954 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3955 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3956 * the peer.
3957 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3958 * by the peer
3959 */
3960 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3961 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3962 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3963 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3964 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3965 };
3966
3967 /**
3968 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3969 *
3970 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3971 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3972 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3973 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3974 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3975 *
3976 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3977 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3978 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3979 */
3980 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3981 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3982 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3983 };
3984
3985 /**
3986 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3987 *
3988 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3989 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3990 *
3991 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3992 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3993 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3994 * of wowlan configuration)
3995 */
3996 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3997 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3998 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3999 };
4000
4001 /**
4002 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
4003 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
4004 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
4005 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
4006 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
4007 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
4008 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
4009 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
4010 * while just having been associated
4011 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
4012 * 0 for a non-MLO connection.
4013 */
4014 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
4015 u16 duration;
4016 u16 subtype;
4017 u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
4018 int link_id;
4019 };
4020
4021 /**
4022 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
4023 *
4024 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
4025 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
4026 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
4027 *
4028 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
4029 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
4030 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
4031 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
4032 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
4033 * Must be atomic.
4034 *
4035 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
4036 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
4037 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
4038 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
4039 * or zero.
4040 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
4041 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
4042 * is added.
4043 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
4044 *
4045 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
4046 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
4047 * it must turn off frame reception.)
4048 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
4049 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
4050 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
4051 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
4052 *
4053 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
4054 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
4055 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
4056 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
4057 * reconfigured at resume time.
4058 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
4059 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
4060 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
4061 * must return 1 from this function.
4062 *
4063 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
4064 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
4065 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
4066 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
4067 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
4068 *
4069 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
4070 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
4071 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
4072 * in suspend().
4073 *
4074 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
4075 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
4076 * and @stop must be implemented.
4077 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
4078 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
4079 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
4080 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
4081 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
4082 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
4083 *
4084 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
4085 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
4086 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
4087 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
4088 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
4089 *
4090 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
4091 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
4092 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
4093 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
4094 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
4095 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
4096 * MAC address of the device going away.
4097 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
4098 *
4099 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
4100 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
4101 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
4102 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
4103 *
4104 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
4105 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
4106 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
4107 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
4108 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
4109 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
4110 * can sleep.
4111 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
4112 * are not implemented.
4113 *
4114 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
4115 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
4116 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
4117 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
4118 * The callback can sleep.
4119 *
4120 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
4121 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
4122 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
4123 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
4124 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
4125 * non-MLO connections.
4126 * The callback can sleep.
4127 *
4128 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
4129 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
4130 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
4131 *
4132 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
4133 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
4134 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
4135 *
4136 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
4137 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
4138 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
4139 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
4140 * which flags are changed.
4141 * This callback can sleep.
4142 *
4143 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
4144 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
4145 *
4146 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
4147 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
4148 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
4149 * is enabled.
4150 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
4151 * The callback can sleep.
4152 *
4153 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
4154 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
4155 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
4156 * The callback must be atomic.
4157 *
4158 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
4159 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
4160 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
4161 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
4162 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
4163 *
4164 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
4165 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
4166 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
4167 *
4168 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
4169 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
4170 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
4171 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
4172 * that power save is disabled.
4173 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
4174 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
4175 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
4176 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
4177 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
4178 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
4179 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
4180 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
4181 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
4182 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
4183 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
4184 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
4185 * The callback can sleep.
4186 *
4187 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
4188 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
4189 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
4190 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
4191 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4192 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4193 * The callback can sleep.
4194 *
4195 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4196 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
4197 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4198 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4199 *
4200 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4201 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4202 *
4203 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4204 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4205 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4206 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4207 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4208 *
4209 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4210 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4211 * this notification.
4212 * The callback can sleep.
4213 *
4214 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4215 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
4216 * The callback can sleep.
4217 *
4218 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4219 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4220 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4221 * The callback must be atomic.
4222 *
4223 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4224 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4225 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4226 * should be set as well.
4227 * The callback can sleep.
4228 *
4229 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4230 * The callback can sleep.
4231 *
4232 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4233 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4234 *
4235 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4236 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4237 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4238 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4239 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4240 * This callback can sleep.
4241 *
4242 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4243 * directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4244 * CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4245 *
4246 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4247 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4248 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4249 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4250 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4251 *
4252 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4253 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4254 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4255 * callback can sleep.
4256 *
4257 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4258 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4259 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4260 * callback can sleep.
4261 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4262 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4263 *
4264 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4265 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4266 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4267 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4268 *
4269 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4270 * power for the station.
4271 * This callback can sleep.
4272 *
4273 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4274 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4275 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4276 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4277 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4278 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4279 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4280 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4281 * The callback can sleep.
4282 *
4283 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4284 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4285 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4286 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4287 * in @sta_state.
4288 * The callback can sleep.
4289 *
4290 * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4291 * be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4292 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4293 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4294 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4295 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4296 * Must be atomic.
4297 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4298 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4299 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4300 *
4301 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4302 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4303 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4304 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4305 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4306 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4307 * The callback can sleep.
4308 *
4309 * @link_sta_statistics: Get link statistics for this station. For example with
4310 * beacon filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be
4311 * accurate, so let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can
4312 * fill most of the values (indicating which by setting the filled
4313 * bitmap), but not all of them make sense - see the source for which
4314 * ones are possible.
4315 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4316 * The callback can sleep.
4317 *
4318 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4319 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4320 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
4321 * The callback can sleep.
4322 *
4323 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4324 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4325 * required function.
4326 * The callback can sleep.
4327 *
4328 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4329 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4330 * required function.
4331 * The callback can sleep.
4332 *
4333 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4334 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4335 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4336 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4337 * The callback can sleep.
4338 *
4339 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4340 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4341 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4342 * TSF synchronization.
4343 * The callback can sleep.
4344 *
4345 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4346 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4347 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4348 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4349 * The callback can sleep.
4350 *
4351 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4352 *
4353 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4354 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4355 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4356 * The callback can sleep.
4357 *
4358 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4359 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4360 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4361 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4362 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4363 *
4364 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4365 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4366 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4367 *
4368 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4369 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4370 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4371 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4372 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4373 * Note that vif can be NULL.
4374 * The callback can sleep.
4375 *
4376 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4377 * the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4378 * The callback can sleep.
4379 *
4380 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4381 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4382 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4383 * completion of the channel switch.
4384 *
4385 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4386 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4387 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4388 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4389 *
4390 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4391 *
4392 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4393 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4394 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4395 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4396 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4397 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4398 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4399 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4400 * must be accepted in this case.
4401 * This callback may sleep.
4402 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4403 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4404 *
4405 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4406 *
4407 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4408 *
4409 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4410 * queues before entering power save.
4411 *
4412 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4413 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4414 * The callback can sleep.
4415 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4416 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4417 * The callback must be atomic.
4418 *
4419 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4420 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4421 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4422 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4423 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4424 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4425 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4426 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4427 * more-data bit must always be set.
4428 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4429 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4430 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4431 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4432 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4433 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4434 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4435 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4436 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4437 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4438 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4439 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4440 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4441 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4442 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4443 * This callback must be atomic.
4444 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4445 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4446 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4447 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4448 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4449 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4450 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4451 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4452 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4453 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4454 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4455 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4456 * This callback must be atomic.
4457 *
4458 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4459 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4460 * expected to return a static value.
4461 *
4462 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4463 *
4464 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4465 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4466 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4467 * expected to return a static value.
4468 *
4469 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4470 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4471 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4472 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4473 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4474 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4475 * management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4476 * to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4477 * able to synchronize with the GO.
4478 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4479 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4480 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4481 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4482 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4483 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4484 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4485 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4486 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4487 * Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
4488 * example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
4489 *
4490 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4491 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4492 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4493 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4494 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4495 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4496 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4497 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4498 *
4499 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4500 * This callback may sleep.
4501 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4502 * This callback may sleep.
4503 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4504 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4505 * channel context with different settings
4506 * This callback may sleep.
4507 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4508 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4509 * This callback may sleep.
4510 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4511 * unbound from vif.
4512 * This callback may sleep.
4513 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4514 * another, as specified in the list of
4515 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4516 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4517 * This callback may sleep.
4518 *
4519 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4520 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4521 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4522 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4523 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4524 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4525 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4526 *
4527 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4528 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4529 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4530 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4531 * This callback may sleep.
4532 *
4533 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4534 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4535 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4536 *
4537 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4538 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4539 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4540 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4541 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4542 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4543 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4544 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4545 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4546 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4547 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4548 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4549 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4550 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4551 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4552 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4553 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4554 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4555 * when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4556 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4557 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4558 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4559 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4560 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4561 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4562 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4563 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4564 *
4565 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4566 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4567 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4568 *
4569 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4570 * and hardware limits.
4571 *
4572 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4573 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4574 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4575 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4576 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4577 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4578 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4579 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4580 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4581 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4582 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4583 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4584 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4585 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4586 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4587 * the function call.
4588 *
4589 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4590 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4591 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4592 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4593 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4594 *
4595 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4596 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4597 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4598 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4599 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4600 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4601 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4602 * changed parameters.
4603 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4604 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4605 * this call.
4606 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4607 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4608 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4609 * @nan_peer_sched_changed: Notifies the driver that the peer NAN schedule
4610 * has changed. The new schedule is available via sta->nan_sched.
4611 * Note that the channel_entry blob might not match the actual chandef
4612 * since the bandwidth of the chandef is the minimum of the local and peer
4613 * bandwidth. It is the driver responsibility to remove the peer schedule
4614 * when the NMI station is removed.
4615 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4616 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4617 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4618 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4619 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4620 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4621 *
4622 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4623 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4624 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4625 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4626 * This callback may sleep.
4627 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4628 * This callback may sleep.
4629 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4630 * 4-address mode
4631 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4632 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4633 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4634 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4635 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4636 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4637 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4638 * twt structure.
4639 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4640 * from the peer.
4641 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4642 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4643 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4644 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4645 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4646 * radar channel.
4647 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4648 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4649 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4650 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4651 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4652 * supported by the driver.
4653 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4654 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4655 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4656 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4657 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4658 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4659 * Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
4660 * will be ignored in a removal only case.
4661 * This callback can sleep.
4662 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4663 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4664 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4665 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4666 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4667 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4668 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4669 * that.
4670 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4671 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4672 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4673 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4674 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4675 * if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4676 * If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4677 * modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4678 * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4679 * drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4680 * the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4681 * interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4682 * implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4683 * &enum nl80211_iftype.
4684 * @set_eml_op_mode: Configure eMLSR/eMLMR operation mode in the underlay
4685 * driver according to the parameter received in the EML Operating mode
4686 * notification frame.
4687 */
4688 struct ieee80211_ops {
4689 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4690 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4691 struct sk_buff *skb);
4692 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4693 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4694 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4695 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4696 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4697 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4698 #endif
4699 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4700 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4701 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4702 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4703 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4704 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4705 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4706 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx, u32 changed);
4707 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4708 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4709 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4710 u64 changed);
4711 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4712 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4713 u64 changed);
4714 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4715 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4716 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4717 u64 changed);
4718
4719 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4720 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4721 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4722 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4723
4724 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4725 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4726 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4727 unsigned int changed_flags,
4728 unsigned int *total_flags,
4729 u64 multicast);
4730 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4731 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4732 unsigned int filter_flags,
4733 unsigned int changed_flags);
4734 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4735 bool set);
4736 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4737 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4738 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4739 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4740 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4741 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4742 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4743 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4744 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4745 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4746 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4747 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4748 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4749 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4750 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4751 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4752 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4753 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4754 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4755 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4756 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4757 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4758 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4759 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4760 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4761 const u8 *mac_addr);
4762 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4763 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4764 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4765 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4766 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4767 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4768 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4769 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4770 u32 value);
4771 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4772 u32 value);
4773 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4774 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4775 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4776 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4777 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4778 void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4779 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4780 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4781 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4782 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4783 struct dentry *dir);
4784 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4785 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4786 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4787 struct dentry *dir);
4788 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4789 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4790 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4791 struct dentry *dir);
4792 #endif
4793 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4794 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4795 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4796 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4797 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4798 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4799 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4800 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4801 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4802 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4803 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4804 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4805 void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4806 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4807 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4808 u32 changed);
4809 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4810 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4811 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4812 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4814 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4815 struct station_info *sinfo);
4816 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4818 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4819 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4820 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4821 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4822 u64 tsf);
4823 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4824 s64 offset);
4825 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4826 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4827 void (*link_sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4828 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4829 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4830 struct link_station_info *link_sinfo);
4831
4832 /**
4833 * @ampdu_action:
4834 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4835 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4836 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4837 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4838 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4839 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4840 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4841 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4842 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4843 *
4844 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4845 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4846 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4847 *
4848 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4849 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4850 *
4851 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4852 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4853 * - ``TX: 81``
4854 *
4855 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4856 *
4857 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4858 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4859 * if the session can start immediately.
4860 *
4861 * The callback can sleep.
4862 */
4863 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4864 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4865 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4866 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4867 struct survey_info *survey);
4868 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4869 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4870 s16 coverage_class);
4871 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4872 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4873 void *data, int len);
4874 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4875 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4876 void *data, int len);
4877 #endif
4878 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4879 u32 queues, bool drop);
4880 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4881 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4882 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4883 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4884 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4885 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4886 u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4887 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4888 u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4889
4890 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4891 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4892 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4893 int duration,
4894 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4895 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4896 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4897 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4898 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4899 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4900 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4901 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4902 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4903 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4904 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4905 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4906
4907 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4908 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4909 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4910 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4911 bool more_data);
4912 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4913 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4914 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4915 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4916 bool more_data);
4917
4918 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4919 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4920 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4921 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4922 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4923 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4924 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4925 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4926
4927 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4928 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4929 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4930 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4931 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4932 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4933
4934 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4935 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4936 unsigned int link_id);
4937
4938 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4939 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4940 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4941 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4942 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4943 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4944 u32 changed);
4945 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4946 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4947 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4948 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4949 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4950 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4951 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4952 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4953 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4954 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4955 int n_vifs,
4956 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4957
4958 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4959 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4960
4961 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4962 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4963 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4964 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4965 #endif
4966 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4967 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4968 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4969 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4970 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4971 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4972
4973 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4974 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4975 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4976 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4977 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4978 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4979 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4980 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4981 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4982
4983 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4984 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4985 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4986 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4987 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4988 unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4989
4990 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4991 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4992 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4993 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4994 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4995 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4996 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4997 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4998 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4999 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5000 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
5001
5002 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5003 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
5004 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5005
5006 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5007 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5008 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
5009 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5010 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5011 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5012 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5013 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
5014 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5015 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5016 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
5017 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5018 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5019 u8 instance_id);
5020 int (*nan_peer_sched_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5021 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5022 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5023 struct sk_buff *head,
5024 struct sk_buff *skb);
5025 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5026 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5027 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
5028 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5029 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
5030 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5031 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
5032 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5033 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5034 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5035 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
5036 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5037 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5038 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
5039 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5040 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5041 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5042 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
5043 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5044 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
5045 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5046 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5047 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
5048 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5049 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5050 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
5051 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5052 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
5053 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5054 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
5055 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5056 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5057 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5058 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
5059 struct net_device_path *path);
5060 bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5061 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5062 u16 active_links);
5063 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5064 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5065 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
5066 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
5067 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5068 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5069 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5070 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
5071 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5072 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5073 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
5074 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5075 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5076 struct net_device *dev,
5077 enum tc_setup_type type,
5078 void *type_data);
5079 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
5080 (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5081 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
5082 void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5083 enum nl80211_iftype type);
5084 int (*set_eml_op_mode)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5085 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5086 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5087 struct ieee80211_eml_params *eml_params);
5088 };
5089
5090 /**
5091 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
5092 *
5093 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
5094 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
5095 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
5096 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
5097 * @priv_data_len.
5098 *
5099 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
5100 * @ops: callbacks for this device
5101 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
5102 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
5103 *
5104 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
5105 */
5106 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
5107 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
5108 const char *requested_name);
5109
5110 /**
5111 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
5112 *
5113 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
5114 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
5115 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
5116 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
5117 * @priv_data_len.
5118 *
5119 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
5120 * @ops: callbacks for this device
5121 *
5122 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
5123 */
5124 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)5125 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
5126 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
5127 {
5128 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
5129 }
5130
5131 /**
5132 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
5133 *
5134 * You must call this function before any other functions in
5135 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
5136 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
5137 *
5138 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5139 *
5140 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
5141 */
5142 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5143
5144 /**
5145 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
5146 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
5147 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
5148 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
5149 */
5150 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
5151 int throughput;
5152 int blink_time;
5153 };
5154
5155 /**
5156 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
5157 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
5158 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
5159 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
5160 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
5161 */
5162 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
5163 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
5164 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
5165 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
5166 };
5167
5168 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5169 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5170 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5171 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5172 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5173 const char *
5174 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5175 unsigned int flags,
5176 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5177 unsigned int blink_table_len);
5178 #endif
5179 /**
5180 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
5181 *
5182 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5183 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5184 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5185 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5186 *
5187 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5188 *
5189 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5190 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5191 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5192 {
5193 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5194 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
5195 #else
5196 return NULL;
5197 #endif
5198 }
5199
5200 /**
5201 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
5202 *
5203 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5204 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5205 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5206 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5207 *
5208 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5209 *
5210 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5211 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5212 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5213 {
5214 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5215 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
5216 #else
5217 return NULL;
5218 #endif
5219 }
5220
5221 /**
5222 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
5223 *
5224 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5225 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5226 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5227 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5228 *
5229 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5230 *
5231 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5232 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5233 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5234 {
5235 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5236 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5237 #else
5238 return NULL;
5239 #endif
5240 }
5241
5242 /**
5243 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5244 *
5245 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5246 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5247 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5248 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5249 *
5250 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5251 *
5252 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5253 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5254 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5255 {
5256 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5257 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5258 #else
5259 return NULL;
5260 #endif
5261 }
5262
5263 /**
5264 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5265 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5266 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5267 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5268 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5269 *
5270 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5271 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5272 *
5273 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5274 */
5275 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5276 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5277 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5278 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5279 {
5280 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5281 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5282 blink_table_len);
5283 #else
5284 return NULL;
5285 #endif
5286 }
5287
5288 /**
5289 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5290 *
5291 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5292 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5293 *
5294 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5295 */
5296 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5297
5298 /**
5299 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5300 *
5301 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5302 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5303 * before calling this function.
5304 *
5305 * @hw: the hardware to free
5306 */
5307 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5308
5309 /**
5310 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5311 *
5312 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5313 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5314 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5315 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5316 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5317 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5318 *
5319 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5320 */
5321 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5322
5323 /**
5324 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5325 *
5326 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5327 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5328 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5329 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5330 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5331 *
5332 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5333 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5334 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5335 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5336 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5337 *
5338 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5339 *
5340 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5341 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5342 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5343 * @list: the destination list
5344 */
5345 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5346 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5347
5348 /**
5349 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5350 *
5351 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5352 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5353 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5354 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5355 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5356 *
5357 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5358 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5359 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5360 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5361 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5362 *
5363 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5364 *
5365 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5366 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5367 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5368 * @napi: the NAPI context
5369 */
5370 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5371 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5372
5373 /**
5374 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5375 *
5376 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5377 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5378 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5379 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5380 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5381 *
5382 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5383 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5384 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5385 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5386 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5387 *
5388 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5389 *
5390 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5391 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5392 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5393 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5394 {
5395 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5396 }
5397
5398 /**
5399 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5400 *
5401 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5402 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5403 *
5404 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5405 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5406 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5407 *
5408 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5409 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5410 */
5411 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5412
5413 /**
5414 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5415 *
5416 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5417 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5418 *
5419 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5420 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5421 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5422 *
5423 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5424 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5425 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5426 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5427 struct sk_buff *skb)
5428 {
5429 local_bh_disable();
5430 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5431 local_bh_enable();
5432 }
5433
5434 /**
5435 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5436 *
5437 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5438 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5439 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5440 *
5441 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5442 *
5443 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5444 * each other.
5445 *
5446 * @sta: currently connected sta
5447 * @start: start or stop PS
5448 *
5449 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5450 */
5451 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5452
5453 /**
5454 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5455 * (in process context)
5456 *
5457 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5458 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5459 * applies.
5460 *
5461 * @sta: currently connected sta
5462 * @start: start or stop PS
5463 *
5464 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5465 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5466 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5467 bool start)
5468 {
5469 int ret;
5470
5471 local_bh_disable();
5472 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5473 local_bh_enable();
5474
5475 return ret;
5476 }
5477
5478 /**
5479 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5480 * @sta: currently connected station
5481 *
5482 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5483 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5484 * connected station was received.
5485 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5486 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5487 * be serialized.
5488 */
5489 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5490
5491 /**
5492 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5493 * @sta: currently connected station
5494 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5495 *
5496 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5497 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5498 * from a connected station was received.
5499 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5500 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5501 * serialized.
5502 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5503 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5504 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5505 * checks.
5506 */
5507 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5508
5509 /*
5510 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5511 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5512 */
5513 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5514
5515 /**
5516 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5517 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5518 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5519 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5520 *
5521 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5522 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5523 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5524 *
5525 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5526 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5527 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5528 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5529 *
5530 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5531 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5532 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5533 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5534 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5535 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5536 *
5537 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5538 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5539 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5540 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5541 * use this API.
5542 */
5543 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5544 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5545
5546 /**
5547 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5548 *
5549 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5550 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5551 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5552 *
5553 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5554 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5555 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5556 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5557 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5558 */
5559 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5560 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5561 struct sk_buff *skb,
5562 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5563 int max_rates);
5564
5565 /**
5566 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5567 *
5568 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5569 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5570 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5571 *
5572 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5573 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5574 * @info: tx status information
5575 */
5576 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5577 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5578 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5579
5580 /**
5581 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5582 *
5583 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5584 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5585 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5586 *
5587 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5588 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5589 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5590 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5591 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5592 *
5593 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5594 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5595 */
5596 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5597 struct sk_buff *skb);
5598
5599 /**
5600 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5601 *
5602 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5603 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5604 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5605 *
5606 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5607 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5608 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5609 *
5610 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5611 * @status: tx status information
5612 */
5613 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5614 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5615
5616 /**
5617 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5618 *
5619 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5620 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5621 * specific skbs.
5622 *
5623 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5624 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5625 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5626 *
5627 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5628 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5629 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5630 * @info: tx status information
5631 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5632 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5633 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5634 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5635 {
5636 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5637 .sta = sta,
5638 .info = info,
5639 };
5640
5641 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5642 }
5643
5644 /**
5645 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5646 *
5647 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5648 *
5649 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5650 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5651 * for a single hardware.
5652 *
5653 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5654 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5655 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5656 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5657 struct sk_buff *skb)
5658 {
5659 local_bh_disable();
5660 ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5661 local_bh_enable();
5662 }
5663
5664 /**
5665 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5666 *
5667 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5668 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5669 *
5670 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5671 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5672 *
5673 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5674 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5675 */
5676 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5677 struct sk_buff *skb);
5678
5679 /**
5680 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5681 *
5682 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5683 * connected STA.
5684 *
5685 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5686 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5687 */
5688 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5689
5690 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5691
5692 /**
5693 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5694 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5695 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5696 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5697 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5698 * should be ignored.
5699 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5700 */
5701 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5702 u16 tim_offset;
5703 u16 tim_length;
5704
5705 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5706 u16 mbssid_off;
5707 };
5708
5709 /**
5710 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5711 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5712 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5713 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5714 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5715 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5716 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5717 *
5718 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5719 * obtain the beacon template.
5720 *
5721 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5722 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5723 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5724 * applicable, the CSA count.
5725 *
5726 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5727 *
5728 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5729 */
5730 struct sk_buff *
5731 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5732 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5733 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5734 unsigned int link_id);
5735
5736 /**
5737 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5738 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5739 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5740 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5741 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5742 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5743 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5744 *
5745 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5746 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5747 * requested index.
5748 *
5749 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5750 */
5751 struct sk_buff *
5752 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5753 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5754 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5755 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5756
5757 /**
5758 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5759 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5760 *
5761 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5762 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5763 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5764 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5765 */
5766 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5767 u8 cnt;
5768 struct {
5769 struct sk_buff *skb;
5770 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5771 } bcn[];
5772 };
5773
5774 /**
5775 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5776 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5777 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5778 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5779 *
5780 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5781 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5782 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5783 * one multiple BSSID element.
5784 *
5785 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5786 *
5787 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5788 * %NULL on error.
5789 */
5790 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5791 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5792 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5793 unsigned int link_id);
5794
5795 /**
5796 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5797 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5798 *
5799 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5800 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5801 */
5802 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5803
5804 /**
5805 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5806 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5807 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5808 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5809 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5810 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5811 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5812 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5813 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5814 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5815 *
5816 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5817 * obtain the beacon frame.
5818 *
5819 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5820 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5821 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5822 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5823 *
5824 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5825 *
5826 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5827 */
5828 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5829 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5830 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5831 unsigned int link_id);
5832
5833 /**
5834 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5835 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5836 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5837 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5838 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5839 *
5840 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5841 *
5842 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5843 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5844 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5845 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5846 unsigned int link_id)
5847 {
5848 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5849 }
5850
5851 /**
5852 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5853 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5854 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5855 *
5856 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5857 * This function is called implicitly when
5858 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5859 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5860 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5861 *
5862 * Return: new countdown value
5863 */
5864 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5865 unsigned int link_id);
5866
5867 /**
5868 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5869 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5870 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5871 *
5872 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5873 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5874 *
5875 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5876 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5877 */
5878 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5879
5880 /**
5881 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5882 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5883 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5884 *
5885 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5886 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5887 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5888 */
5889 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5890
5891 /**
5892 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5893 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5894 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5895 *
5896 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5897 */
5898 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5899 unsigned int link_id);
5900
5901 /**
5902 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5903 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5904 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5905 *
5906 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5907 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5908 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5909 */
5910 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5911
5912 /**
5913 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5914 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5915 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5916 *
5917 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5918 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5919 *
5920 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5921 *
5922 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5923 */
5924 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5925 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5926
5927 /**
5928 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5929 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5930 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5931 *
5932 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5933 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5934 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5935 *
5936 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5937 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5938 *
5939 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5940 */
5941 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5942 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5943
5944 /**
5945 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5946 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5947 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5948 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5949 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5950 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5951 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5952 * if at all possible
5953 *
5954 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5955 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5956 * BSSID and address is used.
5957 *
5958 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5959 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5960 *
5961 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5962 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5963 *
5964 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5965 */
5966 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5967 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5968 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5969
5970 /**
5971 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5972 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5973 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5974 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5975 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5976 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5977 *
5978 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5979 * hardware.
5980 *
5981 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5982 */
5983 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5984 const u8 *src_addr,
5985 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5986 size_t tailroom);
5987
5988 /**
5989 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5990 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5991 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5992 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5993 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5994 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5995 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5996 *
5997 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5998 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5999 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
6000 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
6001 */
6002 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6003 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
6004 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
6005 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
6006
6007 /**
6008 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
6009 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6010 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6011 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
6012 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6013 *
6014 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
6015 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
6016 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
6017 *
6018 * Return: The duration.
6019 */
6020 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6021 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
6022 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
6023
6024 /**
6025 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
6026 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6027 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6028 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
6029 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
6030 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6031 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
6032 *
6033 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
6034 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
6035 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
6036 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
6037 */
6038 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6039 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6040 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
6041 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
6042 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
6043
6044 /**
6045 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
6046 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6047 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6048 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
6049 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6050 *
6051 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
6052 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
6053 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
6054 *
6055 * Return: The duration.
6056 */
6057 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6058 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6059 size_t frame_len,
6060 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
6061
6062 /**
6063 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
6064 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6065 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6066 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
6067 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
6068 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
6069 *
6070 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
6071 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
6072 *
6073 * Return: The duration.
6074 */
6075 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6076 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6077 enum nl80211_band band,
6078 size_t frame_len,
6079 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
6080
6081 /**
6082 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
6083 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6084 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6085 *
6086 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
6087 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
6088 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
6089 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
6090 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
6091 *
6092 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
6093 * frames are available.
6094 *
6095 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
6096 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
6097 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
6098 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
6099 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
6100 * use common code for all beacons.
6101 */
6102 struct sk_buff *
6103 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6104
6105 /**
6106 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
6107 *
6108 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
6109 *
6110 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6111 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
6112 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6113 */
6114 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6115 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
6116
6117 /**
6118 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
6119 *
6120 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
6121 * from the given packet.
6122 *
6123 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6124 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
6125 * with this P1K
6126 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6127 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)6128 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6129 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
6130 {
6131 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
6132 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
6133 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
6134
6135 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
6136 }
6137
6138 /**
6139 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
6140 *
6141 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
6142 * and transmitter address.
6143 *
6144 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6145 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
6146 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
6147 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6148 */
6149 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6150 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
6151
6152 /**
6153 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
6154 *
6155 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
6156 * in the packet.
6157 *
6158 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6159 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
6160 * encrypted with this key
6161 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
6162 */
6163 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6164 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
6165
6166 /**
6167 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
6168 *
6169 * @pos: start of crypto header
6170 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6171 * @pn: PN to add
6172 *
6173 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
6174 * the packet payload)
6175 *
6176 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
6177 * point to the crypto header)
6178 */
6179 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
6180
6181 /**
6182 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
6183 *
6184 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6185 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6186 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6187 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6188 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
6189 *
6190 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
6191 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
6192 * by the device and not by mac80211.
6193 *
6194 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6195 * can be done concurrently.
6196 */
6197 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6198 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6199
6200 /**
6201 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
6202 *
6203 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6204 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6205 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6206 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6207 * @seq: new sequence data
6208 *
6209 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
6210 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
6211 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
6212 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6213 *
6214 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6215 * can be done concurrently.
6216 */
6217 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6218 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6219
6220 /**
6221 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6222 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6223 * @idx: the keyidx of the key
6224 * @key_data: the key data
6225 * @key_len: the key data. Might be bigger than the actual key length,
6226 * but not smaller (for the driver convinence)
6227 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6228 *
6229 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6230 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6231 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6232 *
6233 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6234 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6235 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6236 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6237 *
6238 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6239 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6240 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6241 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6242 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6243 * of the reconfiguration.
6244 *
6245 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6246 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6247 *
6248 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6249 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call.
6250 */
6251 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6252 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6253 u8 idx, u8 *key_data, u8 key_len,
6254 int link_id);
6255
6256 /**
6257 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6258 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6259 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6260 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6261 * @gfp: allocation flags
6262 */
6263 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6264 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6265
6266 /**
6267 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6268 *
6269 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6270 * at the same time.
6271 *
6272 * @keyconf: the key in question
6273 */
6274 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6275
6276 /**
6277 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6278 *
6279 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6280 * at the same time.
6281 *
6282 * @keyconf: the key in question
6283 */
6284 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6285
6286 /**
6287 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6288 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6289 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6290 *
6291 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6292 */
6293 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6294
6295 /**
6296 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6297 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6298 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6299 *
6300 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6301 */
6302 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6303
6304 /**
6305 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6306 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6307 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6308 *
6309 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6310 *
6311 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6312 */
6313
6314 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6315
6316 /**
6317 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6318 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6319 *
6320 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6321 */
6322 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6323
6324 /**
6325 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6326 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6327 *
6328 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6329 */
6330 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6331
6332 /**
6333 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6334 *
6335 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6336 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6337 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6338 * any context, including hardirq context.
6339 *
6340 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6341 * @info: information about the completed scan
6342 */
6343 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6344 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6345
6346 /**
6347 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6348 *
6349 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6350 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6351 *
6352 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6353 */
6354 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6355
6356 /**
6357 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6358 *
6359 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6360 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6361 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6362 * while associating, for instance.
6363 *
6364 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6365 */
6366 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6367
6368 /**
6369 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6370 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6371 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6372 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6373 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6374 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6375 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6376 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6377 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6378 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6379 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6380 * for instance.
6381 */
6382 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6383 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
6384 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
6385 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
6386 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
6387 };
6388
6389 /**
6390 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6391 *
6392 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6393 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6394 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6395 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6396 *
6397 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6398 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6399 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6400 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6401 */
6402 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6403 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6404 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6405 void *data);
6406
6407 /**
6408 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6409 *
6410 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6411 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6412 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6413 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6414 * be used.
6415 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6416 *
6417 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6418 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6419 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6420 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6421 */
6422 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6423 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6424 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6425 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6426 void *data)
6427 {
6428 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6429 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6430 iterator, data);
6431 }
6432
6433 /**
6434 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6435 *
6436 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6437 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6438 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6439 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6440 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6441 *
6442 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6443 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6444 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6445 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6446 */
6447 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6448 u32 iter_flags,
6449 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6450 u8 *mac,
6451 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6452 void *data);
6453
6454 struct ieee80211_vif *
6455 __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6456 struct ieee80211_vif *prev,
6457 u32 iter_flags);
6458
6459 /**
6460 * for_each_interface - iterate interfaces under wiphy mutex
6461 * @vif: the iterator variable
6462 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6463 * @flags: the iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6464 */
6465 #define for_each_interface(vif, hw, flags) \
6466 for (vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, NULL, flags); \
6467 vif; \
6468 vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, vif, flags))
6469
6470 /**
6471 * for_each_active_interface - iterate active interfaces under wiphy mutex
6472 * @vif: the iterator variable
6473 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6474 */
6475 #define for_each_active_interface(vif, hw) \
6476 for_each_interface(vif, hw, IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
6477
6478 /**
6479 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6480 *
6481 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6482 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6483 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6484 *
6485 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6486 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6487 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6488 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6489 */
6490 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6491 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6492 u32 iter_flags,
6493 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6494 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6495 void *data)
6496 {
6497 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
6498
6499 for_each_interface(vif, hw, iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
6500 iterator(data, vif->addr, vif);
6501 }
6502
6503 /**
6504 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6505 *
6506 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6507 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6508 * function for them.
6509 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6510 *
6511 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6512 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6513 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6514 */
6515 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6516 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6517 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6518 void *data);
6519
6520 struct ieee80211_sta *
6521 __ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6522 struct ieee80211_sta *prev);
6523
6524 /**
6525 * for_each_station - iterate stations under wiphy mutex
6526 * @sta: the iterator variable
6527 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6528 */
6529 #define for_each_station(sta, hw) \
6530 for (sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, NULL); \
6531 sta; \
6532 sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, sta))
6533
6534 /**
6535 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6536 *
6537 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6538 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6539 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6540 * mutex.
6541 *
6542 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6543 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6544 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6545 */
6546 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,void (* iterator)(void * data,struct ieee80211_sta * sta),void * data)6547 ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6548 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6549 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6550 void *data)
6551 {
6552 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
6553
6554 for_each_station(sta, hw)
6555 iterator(data, sta);
6556 }
6557
6558 /**
6559 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6560 *
6561 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6562 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6563 *
6564 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6565 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6566 */
6567 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6568
6569 /**
6570 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6571 *
6572 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6573 * workqueue.
6574 *
6575 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6576 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6577 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6578 */
6579 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6580 struct delayed_work *dwork,
6581 unsigned long delay);
6582
6583 /**
6584 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6585 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6586 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6587 *
6588 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6589 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6590 * mac80211.
6591 *
6592 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6593 */
6594 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6595 u16 tid);
6596
6597 /**
6598 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6599 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6600 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6601 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6602 *
6603 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6604 *
6605 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6606 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6607 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6608 */
6609 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6610 u16 timeout);
6611
6612 /**
6613 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6614 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6615 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6616 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6617 *
6618 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6619 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6620 * from any context.
6621 */
6622 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6623 u16 tid);
6624
6625 /**
6626 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6627 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6628 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6629 *
6630 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6631 *
6632 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6633 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6634 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6635 */
6636 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6637
6638 /**
6639 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6640 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6641 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6642 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6643 *
6644 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6645 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6646 * can be called from any context.
6647 */
6648 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6649 u16 tid);
6650
6651 /**
6652 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6653 *
6654 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6655 * @addr: station's address
6656 *
6657 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6658 *
6659 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6660 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6661 */
6662 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6663 const u8 *addr);
6664
6665 /**
6666 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6667 *
6668 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6669 * @addr: remote station's address
6670 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6671 *
6672 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6673 *
6674 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6675 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6676 *
6677 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6678 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6679 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6680 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6681 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6682 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6683 * is not reliable.
6684 *
6685 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6686 */
6687 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6688 const u8 *addr,
6689 const u8 *localaddr);
6690
6691 /**
6692 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6693 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6694 * @addr: remote station's link address
6695 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6696 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6697 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6698 *
6699 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6700 *
6701 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6702 */
6703 struct ieee80211_sta *
6704 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6705 const u8 *addr,
6706 const u8 *localaddr,
6707 unsigned int *link_id);
6708
6709 /**
6710 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6711 * @hw: the hardware
6712 * @pubsta: the station
6713 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6714 *
6715 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6716 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6717 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6718 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6719 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6720 *
6721 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6722 * manner.
6723 *
6724 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6725 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6726 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6727 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6728 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6729 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6730 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6731 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6732 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6733 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6734 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6735 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6736 * woke up while blocked or not.
6737 */
6738 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6739 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6740
6741 /**
6742 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6743 * @pubsta: the station
6744 *
6745 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6746 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6747 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6748 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6749 *
6750 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6751 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6752 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6753 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6754 *
6755 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6756 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6757 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6758 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6759 */
6760 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6761
6762 /**
6763 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6764 * @pubsta: the station
6765 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6766 *
6767 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6768 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6769 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6770 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6771 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6772 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6773 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6774 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6775 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6776 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6777 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6778 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6779 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6780 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6781 */
6782 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6783
6784 /**
6785 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6786 * @pubsta: the station
6787 *
6788 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6789 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6790 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6791 *
6792 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6793 * there is no need to call this function.
6794 */
6795 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6796
6797 /**
6798 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6799 *
6800 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6801 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6802 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6803 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6804 *
6805 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6806 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6807 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6808 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6809 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6810 * attempts.
6811 *
6812 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6813 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6814 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6815 * them to 0.
6816 *
6817 * @pubsta: the station
6818 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6819 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6820 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6821 */
6822 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6823 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6824
6825 /**
6826 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6827 *
6828 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6829 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6830 *
6831 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6832 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6833 */
6834 bool
6835 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6836
6837 /**
6838 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6839 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6840 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6841 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6842 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6843 *
6844 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6845 *
6846 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6847 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6848 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6849 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6850 *
6851 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6852 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6853 * set_key callback.
6854 */
6855 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6856 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6857 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6858 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6859 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6860 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6861 void *data),
6862 void *iter_data);
6863
6864 /**
6865 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6866 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6867 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6868 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6869 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6870 *
6871 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6872 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6873 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6874 * in removal process will be skipped.
6875 *
6876 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6877 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6878 */
6879 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6880 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6881 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6882 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6883 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6884 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6885 void *data),
6886 void *iter_data);
6887
6888 /**
6889 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6890 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6891 * @iter: iterator function
6892 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6893 *
6894 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6895 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6896 * places while calling into the driver.
6897 *
6898 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6899 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6900 * removed.
6901 *
6902 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6903 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6904 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6905 * or not.
6906 */
6907 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6908 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6909 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6910 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6911 void *data),
6912 void *iter_data);
6913
6914 /**
6915 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx - iterate channel contexts
6916 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6917 * @iter: iterator function
6918 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6919 *
6920 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function can only be used while
6921 * holding the wiphy mutex.
6922 *
6923 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6924 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6925 * removed.
6926 *
6927 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6928 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6929 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6930 * or not.
6931 */
6932 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx(
6933 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6934 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6935 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6936 void *data),
6937 void *iter_data);
6938
6939 /**
6940 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6941 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6942 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6943 *
6944 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6945 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6946 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6947 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6948 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6949 * %NULL.
6950 *
6951 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6952 */
6953 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6954 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6955
6956 /**
6957 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6958 *
6959 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6960 *
6961 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6962 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6963 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6964 */
6965 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6966
6967 /**
6968 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6969 *
6970 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6971 *
6972 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6973 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6974 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6975 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6976 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6977 *
6978 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6979 * without connection recovery attempts.
6980 */
6981 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6982
6983 /**
6984 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6985 *
6986 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6987 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6988 *
6989 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6990 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6991 */
6992 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6993
6994 /**
6995 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6996 *
6997 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6998 *
6999 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
7000 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
7001 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
7002 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
7003 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
7004 *
7005 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
7006 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
7007 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
7008 * disconnect normally later.
7009 *
7010 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
7011 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
7012 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
7013 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
7014 */
7015 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7016
7017 /**
7018 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
7019 * hardware restart
7020 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7021 *
7022 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
7023 * hardware restart.
7024 */
7025 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7026
7027 /**
7028 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
7029 * rssi threshold triggered
7030 *
7031 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7032 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
7033 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
7034 * @gfp: context flags
7035 *
7036 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
7037 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
7038 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
7039 */
7040 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7041 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
7042 s32 rssi_level,
7043 gfp_t gfp);
7044
7045 /**
7046 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
7047 *
7048 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7049 * @gfp: context flags
7050 */
7051 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
7052
7053 /**
7054 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
7055 *
7056 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7057 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
7058 * pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
7059 */
7060 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7061 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
7062
7063 /**
7064 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
7065 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7066 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
7067 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
7068 * false.
7069 *
7070 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
7071 * and wake up the suspended queues.
7072 */
7073 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
7074 unsigned int link_id);
7075
7076 /**
7077 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
7078 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7079 *
7080 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
7081 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
7082 * a deauth frame in this case.
7083 */
7084 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7085
7086 /**
7087 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
7088 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7089 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
7090 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
7091 *
7092 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
7093 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
7094 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
7095 */
7096 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7097 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
7098
7099 /**
7100 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
7101 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7102 */
7103 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7104
7105 /**
7106 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7107 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7108 */
7109 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7110
7111 /**
7112 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
7113 *
7114 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
7115 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
7116 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
7117 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
7118 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
7119 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
7120 *
7121 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7122 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
7123 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
7124 */
7125 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
7126 const u8 *addr);
7127
7128 /**
7129 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
7130 * @pubsta: station struct
7131 * @tid: the session's TID
7132 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
7133 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
7134 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
7135 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
7136 *
7137 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
7138 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
7139 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
7140 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
7141 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
7142 */
7143 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
7144 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
7145 u16 received_mpdus);
7146
7147 /**
7148 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
7149 *
7150 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
7151 * buffer.
7152 *
7153 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7154 * @ra: the peer's destination address
7155 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
7156 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
7157 */
7158 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
7159
7160 /**
7161 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
7162 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7163 * @addr: station mac address
7164 * @tid: the rx tid
7165 */
7166 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
7167 unsigned int tid);
7168
7169 /**
7170 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
7171 *
7172 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
7173 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
7174 * reordering.
7175 *
7176 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
7177 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
7178 *
7179 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7180 * @addr: station mac address
7181 * @tid: the rx tid
7182 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)7183 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7184 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
7185 {
7186 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
7187 return;
7188 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
7189 }
7190
7191 /**
7192 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
7193 *
7194 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
7195 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
7196 * reordering.
7197 *
7198 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
7199 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
7200 *
7201 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7202 * @addr: station mac address
7203 * @tid: the rx tid
7204 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)7205 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7206 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
7207 {
7208 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
7209 return;
7210 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
7211 }
7212
7213 /**
7214 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
7215 *
7216 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
7217 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
7218 *
7219 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
7220 *
7221 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7222 * @addr: station mac address
7223 * @tid: the rx tid
7224 */
7225 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7226 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
7227
7228 /* Rate control API */
7229
7230 /**
7231 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
7232 *
7233 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
7234 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
7235 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
7236 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
7237 * to be filled in
7238 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
7239 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
7240 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
7241 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
7242 * RTS threshold
7243 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
7244 * if the selected rate supports it
7245 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
7246 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
7247 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
7248 */
7249 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
7250 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
7251 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
7252 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
7253 struct sk_buff *skb;
7254 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
7255 bool rts, short_preamble;
7256 u32 rate_idx_mask;
7257 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
7258 bool bss;
7259 };
7260
7261 /**
7262 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
7263 */
7264 enum rate_control_capabilities {
7265 /**
7266 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
7267 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
7268 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
7269 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
7270 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
7271 */
7272 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
7273 /**
7274 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
7275 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
7276 */
7277 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7278 };
7279
7280 struct rate_control_ops {
7281 unsigned long capa;
7282 const char *name;
7283 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7284 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7285 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7286 void (*free)(void *priv);
7287
7288 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7289 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7290 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7291 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7292 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7293 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7294 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7295 u32 changed);
7296 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7297 void *priv_sta);
7298
7299 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7300 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7301 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7302 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7303 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7304 struct sk_buff *skb);
7305 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7306 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7307
7308 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7309 struct dentry *dir);
7310
7311 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7312 };
7313
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7314 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7315 enum nl80211_band band,
7316 int index)
7317 {
7318 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7319 }
7320
7321 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7322 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7323 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7324 {
7325 int i;
7326
7327 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7328 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7329 return i;
7330
7331 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7332 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7333
7334 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7335 return 0;
7336 }
7337
7338 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7339 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7340 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7341 {
7342 unsigned int i;
7343
7344 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7345 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7346 return true;
7347 return false;
7348 }
7349
7350 /**
7351 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7352 *
7353 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7354 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7355 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7356 * the most recent rate control module decision.
7357 *
7358 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7359 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7360 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7361 *
7362 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7363 */
7364 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7365 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7366 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7367
7368 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7369 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7370
7371 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7372 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7373 {
7374 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7375 }
7376
7377 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7378 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7379 {
7380 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7381 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7382 }
7383
7384 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7385 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7386 {
7387 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7388 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7389 }
7390
7391 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7392 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7393 {
7394 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7395 }
7396
7397 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7398 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7399 {
7400 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7401 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7402 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7403 }
7404
7405 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7406 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7407 {
7408 if (p2p) {
7409 switch (type) {
7410 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7411 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7412 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7413 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7414 default:
7415 break;
7416 }
7417 }
7418 return type;
7419 }
7420
7421 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7422 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7423 {
7424 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7425 }
7426
7427 /**
7428 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7429 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7430 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7431 *
7432 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7433 */
7434 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7435 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7436 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7437 {
7438 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7439 }
7440
7441 /**
7442 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7443 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7444 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7445 *
7446 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7447 */
7448 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7449 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7450 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7451 {
7452 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7453 }
7454
7455 /**
7456 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return EHT capabilities for sband/vif
7457 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7458 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7459 *
7460 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7461 */
7462 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7463 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7464 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7465 {
7466 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7467 }
7468
7469 /**
7470 * ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif - return UHR capabilities for sband/vif
7471 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7472 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7473 *
7474 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap, or %NULL is none found
7475 */
7476 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap *
ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7477 ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7478 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7479 {
7480 return ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7481 }
7482
7483 /**
7484 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7485 *
7486 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7487 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7488 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7489 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7490 *
7491 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7492 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7493 * matching GroupId management frame.
7494 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7495 */
7496 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7497 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7498
7499 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7500 int rssi_min_thold,
7501 int rssi_max_thold);
7502
7503 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7504
7505 /**
7506 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7507 *
7508 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7509 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO
7510 *
7511 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7512 *
7513 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7514 * applicable.
7515 */
7516 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int link_id);
7517
7518 /**
7519 * ieee80211_calculate_rx_timestamp - calculate timestamp in frame
7520 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7521 * @status: RX status
7522 * @mpdu_len: total MPDU length (including FCS)
7523 * @mpdu_offset: offset into MPDU to calculate timestamp at
7524 *
7525 * This function calculates the RX timestamp at the given MPDU offset, taking
7526 * into account what the RX timestamp was. An offset of 0 will just normalize
7527 * the timestamp to TSF at beginning of MPDU reception.
7528 *
7529 * Returns: the calculated timestamp
7530 */
7531 u64 ieee80211_calculate_rx_timestamp(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7532 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7533 unsigned int mpdu_len,
7534 unsigned int mpdu_offset);
7535
7536 /**
7537 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7538 * @vif: virtual interface
7539 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7540 * @gfp: allocation flags
7541 *
7542 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7543 */
7544 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7545 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7546 gfp_t gfp);
7547
7548 /**
7549 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7550 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7551 * @vif: virtual interface
7552 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7553 * @band: the band to transmit on
7554 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7555 *
7556 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise.
7557 * On failure, the skb is freed by this function; callers must not
7558 * free it again.
7559 *
7560 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7561 */
7562 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7563 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7564 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7565
7566 /**
7567 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7568 * of injected frames.
7569 *
7570 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7571 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7572 * of the skb before calling this function.
7573 *
7574 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7575 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7576 *
7577 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7578 */
7579 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7580 struct net_device *dev);
7581
7582 /**
7583 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7584 *
7585 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7586 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7587 *
7588 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7589 *
7590 * private:
7591 *
7592 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7593 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7594 */
7595 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7596 u32 next_tsf;
7597 bool has_next_tsf;
7598
7599 u8 absent;
7600
7601 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7602 struct {
7603 u32 start;
7604 u32 duration;
7605 u32 interval;
7606 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7607 };
7608
7609 /**
7610 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7611 *
7612 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7613 * @data: NoA tracking data
7614 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7615 *
7616 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7617 */
7618 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7619 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7620
7621 /**
7622 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7623 *
7624 * @data: NoA tracking data
7625 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7626 */
7627 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7628
7629 /**
7630 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7631 * @vif: virtual interface
7632 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7633 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7634 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7635 * @gfp: allocation flags
7636 *
7637 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7638 */
7639 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7640 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7641 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7642
7643 /**
7644 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7645 *
7646 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7647 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7648 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7649 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7650 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7651 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7652 *
7653 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7654 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7655 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7656 *
7657 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7658 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7659 *
7660 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7661 */
7662 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7663
7664 /**
7665 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7666 *
7667 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7668 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7669 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7670 *
7671 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7672 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7673 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7674 *
7675 * @sta: the station
7676 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7677 */
7678 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7679
7680 /**
7681 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7682 *
7683 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7684 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7685 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7686 *
7687 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7688 *
7689 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7690 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7691 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7692 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7693 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7694 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7695 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7696 *
7697 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7698 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7699 */
7700 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7701 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7702
7703 /**
7704 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7705 * (in process context)
7706 *
7707 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7708 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7709 *
7710 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7711 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7712 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7713 *
7714 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7715 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7716 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7717 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7718 {
7719 struct sk_buff *skb;
7720
7721 local_bh_disable();
7722 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7723 local_bh_enable();
7724
7725 return skb;
7726 }
7727
7728 /**
7729 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7730 *
7731 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7732 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7733 *
7734 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7735 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7736 */
7737 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7738 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7739
7740 /**
7741 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7742 *
7743 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7744 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7745 *
7746 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7747 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7748 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7749 */
7750 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7751
7752 /**
7753 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7754 *
7755 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7756 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7757 *
7758 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7759 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7760 */
7761 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7762
7763 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7764 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7765 {
7766 }
7767
7768 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7769 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7770
7771 /**
7772 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7773 *
7774 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7775 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7776 *
7777 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7778 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7779 *
7780 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7781 * this TXQ internally.
7782 */
7783 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7784 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7785 {
7786 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7787 }
7788
7789 /**
7790 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7791 *
7792 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7793 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7794 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7795 *
7796 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7797 * internally.
7798 */
7799 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7800 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7801 bool force)
7802 {
7803 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7804 }
7805
7806 /**
7807 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7808 *
7809 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7810 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7811 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7812 * next_txq().
7813 *
7814 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7815 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7816 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7817 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7818 * again.
7819 *
7820 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7821 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7822 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7823 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7824 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7825 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7826 *
7827 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7828 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7829 *
7830 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7831 */
7832 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7833 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7834
7835 /**
7836 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7837 *
7838 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7839 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7840 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7841 *
7842 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7843 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7844 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7845 */
7846 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7847 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7848 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7849
7850 /**
7851 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7852 *
7853 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7854 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7855 *
7856 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7857 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7858 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7859 * @gfp: allocation flags
7860 */
7861 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7862 u8 inst_id,
7863 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7864 gfp_t gfp);
7865
7866 /**
7867 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7868 *
7869 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7870 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7871 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7872 *
7873 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7874 * @match: match event information
7875 * @gfp: allocation flags
7876 */
7877 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7878 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7879 gfp_t gfp);
7880
7881 /**
7882 * ieee80211_nan_sched_update_done - notify that NAN schedule update is done
7883 *
7884 * This function is called by the driver to notify mac80211 that the NAN
7885 * schedule update has been applied.
7886 * Must be called with wiphy mutex held. May sleep.
7887 *
7888 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7889 */
7890 void ieee80211_nan_sched_update_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7891
7892 /**
7893 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7894 *
7895 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7896 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7897 *
7898 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7899 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7900 * information.
7901 * @len: frame length in bytes
7902 *
7903 * Return: the airtime estimate
7904 */
7905 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7906 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7907 int len);
7908
7909 /**
7910 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7911 *
7912 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7913 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7914 *
7915 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7916 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7917 * @len: frame length in bytes
7918 *
7919 * Return: the airtime estimate
7920 */
7921 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7922 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7923 int len);
7924 /**
7925 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7926 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7927 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7928 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
7929 *
7930 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7931 *
7932 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7933 */
7934 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7935 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7936 unsigned int link_id);
7937
7938 /**
7939 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7940 * probe response template.
7941 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7942 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7943 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
7944 *
7945 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7946 *
7947 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7948 */
7949 struct sk_buff *
7950 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7951 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7952 unsigned int link_id);
7953
7954 /**
7955 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7956 * collision.
7957 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7958 *
7959 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7960 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7961 * aware of.
7962 */
7963 void
7964 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7965 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7966
7967 /**
7968 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7969 *
7970 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7971 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7972 *
7973 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7974 *
7975 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7976 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7977 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7978 {
7979 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7980 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7981
7982 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7983 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7984 }
7985
7986 /**
7987 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7988 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7989 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7990 *
7991 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7992 * back into the driver.
7993 *
7994 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7995 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7996 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7997 *
7998 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7999 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
8000 * a sequence of calls like
8001 *
8002 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
8003 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
8004 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
8005 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
8006 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
8007 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
8008 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
8009 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
8010 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
8011 *
8012 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
8013 */
8014 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
8015
8016 /**
8017 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
8018 * @vif: interface to set active links on
8019 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
8020 *
8021 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
8022 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
8023 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
8024 * completed after it returns.
8025 */
8026 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
8027 u16 active_links);
8028
8029 /**
8030 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
8031 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
8032 *
8033 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
8034 * TTLM request.
8035 */
8036 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
8037
8038 /**
8039 * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
8040 * @width: the channel width value to convert
8041 * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
8042 */
8043 static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)8044 ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
8045 {
8046 switch (width) {
8047 default:
8048 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
8049 fallthrough;
8050 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
8051 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
8052 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
8053 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
8054 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
8055 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
8056 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
8057 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
8058 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
8059 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
8060 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
8061 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
8062 }
8063 }
8064
8065 /**
8066 * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
8067 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
8068 * @bw: the bandwidth requested
8069 *
8070 * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
8071 * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
8072 * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
8073 *
8074 * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
8075 * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
8076 * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
8077 * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
8078 *
8079 * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
8080 * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
8081 * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
8082 *
8083 * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
8084 * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
8085 * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
8086 * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
8087 *
8088 * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
8089 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
8090 * case of HW restart.
8091 *
8092 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
8093 * into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
8094 *
8095 * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
8096 */
8097 bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
8098 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);
8099
8100 /**
8101 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
8102 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
8103 *
8104 * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
8105 * as well.
8106 */
8107 void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);
8108
8109 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
8110 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
8111 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
8112 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
8113 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
8114 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
8115 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
8116 u32 changed);
8117 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
8118 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
8119 int n_vifs,
8120 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
8121
8122 /**
8123 * ieee80211_vif_nan_started - Return whether a NAN vif is started
8124 * @vif: the vif
8125 * Return: %true iff the vif is a NAN interface and NAN is started
8126 */
8127 bool ieee80211_vif_nan_started(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
8128
8129 /**
8130 * ieee80211_encrypt_tx_skb - Encrypt the transmit skb
8131 * @skb: the skb
8132 * Return: 0 if success and non-zero on error
8133 */
8134 int ieee80211_encrypt_tx_skb(struct sk_buff *skb);
8135 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
8136